blob: cbc967a7cabe035debe6f9ca04d7dcf0c4ba8264 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau08d0f232021-08-17 14:08:55 +02007 2021/08/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001113 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001114 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001115 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001116 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1117 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001119 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1120 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001124 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125
1126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128------------------------------------
1129
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001130ca-base <dir>
1131 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001132 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1133 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1134 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001135
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136chroot <jail dir>
1137 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1138 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1139 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1140 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1141 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001144cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001145 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001146 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1147 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1148 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1149 set. These sets have the format
1150
1151 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1152
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001153 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1154 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001155 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001156 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001157 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1158 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001159 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1160 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1161 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1162 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1163 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1164 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1165 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1166 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1167 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1168 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001169
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001170 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1171 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1172 on the machine's word size.
1173
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001174 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001175 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1176 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1177 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1178 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1179 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1180 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001181
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001182 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1183 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1184 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1185 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001187 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001188 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1189 # first 4 CPUs
1190
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001191 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1192 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 # word size.
1194
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001195 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1196 # and so on.
1197 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1200
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001201 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1202 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1203 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1204 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001205
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001206 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1207 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001209
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001210crt-base <dir>
1211 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001212 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1213 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001214
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001215daemon
1216 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1217 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001218 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1219 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001220
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001221default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001222 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001223 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1224 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1225 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1226 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1227 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1228 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1229 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1230 not start with a slash ('/'):
1231 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1232 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1233
1234 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1235 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1236 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1237 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1238 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1239 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1240 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1241 each of them.
1242
1243 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1244 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1245 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1246 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1247 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1248 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1249 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1250 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1251
1252 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1253 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001254 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001255 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1256 made easily relocatable.
1257
1258 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1259 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1260 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1261 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1262 consistent across all configuration files.
1263
1264 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1265 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1266 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1267 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1268 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1269 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1270 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1271 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1272
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1274 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276
1277deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001278 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001279 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1280
1281deviceatlas-separator <char>
1282 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1283 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1284
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001285deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001286 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1287 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1288 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001289
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001290expose-experimental-directives
1291 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1292 the config file will be rejected.
1293
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001294external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001295 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1296 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001297 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1298 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1299 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1300 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1301 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001302
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001304 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001305 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1306 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001307 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001308 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001310
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001311group <group name>
1312 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1313 See also "gid" and "user".
1314
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001315hard-stop-after <time>
1316 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1317
1318 Arguments :
1319 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1320 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1321 SIGUSR1 signal.
1322
1323 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1324 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1325 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1326
1327 Example:
1328 global
1329 hard-stop-after 30s
1330
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001331h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1332 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1333 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1334 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1335 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001336 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001337 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1338 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1339 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1340 specified in a proxy.
1341
1342 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1343 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1344 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1345 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1346 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1347 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1348 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1349
1350 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1351 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1352 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1353 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1354 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1355
1356 Example:
1357 global
1358 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1359
1360 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1361 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1362
1363h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1364 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1365 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1366 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1367 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1368 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1369 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1370 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1371 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1372
1373 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1374 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1375 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1376
1377 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1378 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1379
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001380insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001381 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001382 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1383 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1384 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1385 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1386 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1387 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1388 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001389 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001390 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1391 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1392 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1393 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1394 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1395 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1396 disable it.
1397
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001398insecure-setuid-wanted
1399 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1400 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1401 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1402 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001403 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001404 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1407 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001408 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001409 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1410 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1411 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1412 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1413
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001414issuers-chain-path <dir>
1415 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1416 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1417 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001418 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001419 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1420 "issuers-chain-path".
1421 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1422 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1423 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1424 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1425 will share the chain in memory.
1426
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001427h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1428 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1429 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1430 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1431 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1432 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1433 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1434 the keyword with "no'.
1435
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001436localpeer <name>
1437 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1438 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1439 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1440 the configuration parsing.
1441
1442 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1443 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1444
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001445log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001446 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001447 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001448 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001449 configured with "log global".
1450
1451 <address> can be one of:
1452
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001453 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001454 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1455 port).
1456
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001457 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1458 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1459 port).
1460
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001461 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1463 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001464 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001465
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001466 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1467 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1468 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1469 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1470 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1471 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1472 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1473 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1474 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1475 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001476 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001477 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1478 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1479 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001480 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1481 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001482
1483 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1484 "fd@2", see above.
1485
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001486 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1487 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1488 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1489 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1490 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1491
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001492 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1493 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001494
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001495 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1496 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1497 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1498 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1499 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1500 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1501 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1502 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1503 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1504 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001505 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1506 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001507
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001508 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1509 one of the following :
1510
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001511 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1512 field is stripped. This is the default.
1513 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1514 rfc3164.
1515
1516 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1518
1519 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1520 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1521
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001522 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1523 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1524 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1525 designed to be used with a local log server.
1526
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001527 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1528 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1529 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1530 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1531 logger consumes.
1532
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001533 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1534 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1535 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1536 used with a local log server.
1537
1538 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1539 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1540 designed to be used with a local log server.
1541
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001542 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1543 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1544 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1545 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1546
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001547 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1548 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1549 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1550 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1551 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1552
1553 <sample_size>
1554 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1555 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1556 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1557 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1558 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1559
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001560 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001561
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001562 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1563 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1564 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1565
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001566 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1567 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1568 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1569 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001570
1571 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001572 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1573 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1574 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1575 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1576 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1577 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001579 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001580
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001581log-send-hostname [<string>]
1582 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1583 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1584 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1585 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1586 the logs.
1587
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001588log-tag <string>
1589 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1590 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1591 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001592 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001593
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001594lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001595 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1596 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1597 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1598 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1599 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1600 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001601 used multiple times.
1602
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001603lua-load-per-thread <file>
1604 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1605 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1606 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1607 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1608 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1609 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1610 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1611 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1612 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1613 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1614 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1615 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1616 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1617 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1618 times.
1619
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001620lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1621 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1622 variable.
1623 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1624 to "path".
1625
1626 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1627 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1628 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1629 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1630 will be checked earlier.
1631
1632 As an example by specifying the following path:
1633
1634 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1636
1637 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1638 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1640 paths if that does not exist either.
1641
1642 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1643 documentation.
1644
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001645master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001646 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1647 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1648 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001650 or daemon mode.
1651
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001652 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1653 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1654 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1655 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1656 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001657
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001658 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001659
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660mworker-max-reloads <number>
1661 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001662 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001663 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1664 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1665 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1666
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001667nbthread <number>
1668 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001669 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1670 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1671 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1672 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1673 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1674 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1675 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001676
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001677numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001678 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001679 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1680 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1681 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1682 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1683 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1684 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1685 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1686 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001688pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001689 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1690 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1691 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1692 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001693
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001694pp2-never-send-local
1695 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1696 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1697 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1698 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1699 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1700 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1701 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1702 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1703 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1704 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1705 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1706
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001707presetenv <name> <value>
1708 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1709 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1710 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1711 and "unsetenv".
1712
1713resetenv [<name> ...]
1714 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1715 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1716 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1717 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1718 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1719 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1720 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1721 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1722
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001723stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001724 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1725 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1726 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001727
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001728server-state-base <directory>
1729 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001730 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1731 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001732
1733server-state-file <file>
1734 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1735 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1736 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1737 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1738 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1739 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1740 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1741 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001742 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1743 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001744
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001745set-var <var-name> <expr>
1746 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1747 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1748 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1749 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1750 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1751 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1752 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1753 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1754 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1755
1756 Example:
1757 global
1758 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1759 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1760 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1761
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001762setenv <name> <value>
1763 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1764 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1765 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1766 and "unsetenv".
1767
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001768set-dumpable
1769 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001770 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1771 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1772 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1773 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1774 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1775 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1776 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1777 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1778 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1779 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1780 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1781 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1782 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1783 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1784 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001785 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001786 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001787
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001788ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1790 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001791 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001792 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001793 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1794 information and recommendations see e.g.
1795 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1796 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1797 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1798 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001799
1800ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1802 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1803 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1804 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1805 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001806 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1807 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1808 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001809 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001810
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001811ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1812 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1813 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1814 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1815 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1816 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1817
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001818ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1820 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1821 keyword to see available options.
1822
1823 Example:
1824 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001825 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001826
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001827ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1829 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001830 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001831 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001832 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1833 information and recommendations see e.g.
1834 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1835 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1836 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1837 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1838 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001839
1840ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1842 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1843 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1844 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1845 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001846 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1847 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1848 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1849 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001850
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001851ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1853 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1854 keyword to see available options.
1855
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001856ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1858 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1859 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001861 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001862 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1863 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1864 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1865 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001866 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1867 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1868 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1869
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001870ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1871 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1872 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001873 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001874 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001875 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1876
1877 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001878
1879 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1880 and won't try to remove them.
1881
1882 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1883
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001884ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001885 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001886 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1887 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1888 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001889
1890 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1891 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1892 optimize the startup time.
1893
1894 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1895 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1896 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1897
1898 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001899 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001900
1901 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001902 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1903 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001904
1905 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1906 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1907 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1908 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1909 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001910 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001911
1912 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001913 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001914 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1915 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1916 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1917 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1918 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001919 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001920
1921 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1922
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001923 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924 a cert bundle.
1925
1926 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1927 separately in several "crt".
1928
1929 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1930 since files are loading separately.
1931
1932 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1933 required to commit them.
1934
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001935 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001937
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001938 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1939 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1940 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001941
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001942 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1943 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1944 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001945
1946 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001947 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1948 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001949
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001950 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1951 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1952
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001953 The default behavior is "all".
1954
1955 Example:
1956 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1957 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1958 ssl-load-extra-files none
1959
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001960 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1961 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001962
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001963ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1964 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1965 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1966 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1967
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001968ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001969 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001970 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1971 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1972 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1973 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1974 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1975 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001976 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001977
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001978stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1979 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1980 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1981 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001982 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001983 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001984
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001985 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1986 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1987 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001988
1989stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1990 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1991 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001992 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001993
1994stats maxconn <connections>
1995 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1996 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1997
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001998uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001999 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002000 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2001 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2002 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2003
2004ulimit-n <number>
2005 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2006 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2007 option.
2008
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002009 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2010 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2011 manually specify this value.
2012
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002013unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2014 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2015
2016 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2017 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2018 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2019 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2020 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002021 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002022 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2023 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2024 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2025 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2026
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002027unsetenv [<name> ...]
2028 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2029 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2030 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2031 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2032 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2033 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2034 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2035
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002036user <user name>
2037 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2038 See also "uid" and "group".
2039
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002040node <name>
2041 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2042
2043 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2044 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2045 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2046 traffic.
2047
2048description <text>
2049 Add a text that describes the instance.
2050
2051 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2052 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2053 "<" and ">" characters.
2054
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205551degrees-data-file <file path>
2056 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002059 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002060 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2061
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002063 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2064 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2065 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2066
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002067 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002068 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2069
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002071 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2072 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2073
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002074 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002075 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2076
207751degrees-cache-size <number>
2078 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2079 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2080 By default, this cache is disabled.
2081
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002082 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002083 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2084
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002085wurfl-data-file <file path>
2086 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2087 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2088
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002089 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002090 with USE_WURFL=1.
2091
2092wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2093 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2094 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2095 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2096
2097 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2098
2099 Valid WURFL properties are:
2100 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2101
2102 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2103 device.
2104
2105 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2106 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2107
2108 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2109 particular web request.
2110
2111 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2112 used Libwurfl API version.
2113
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002114 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2115 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2116
2117 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2118 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2119
2120 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2121
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002122 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002123 with USE_WURFL=1.
2124
2125wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2126 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2127 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002129 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002130 with USE_WURFL=1.
2131
2132wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2133 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2134 thus before the chroot.
2135
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002136 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002137 with USE_WURFL=1.
2138
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002139wurfl-cache-size <size>
2140 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2141 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002142 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002143 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002148strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002149 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002150 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2151 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002153 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021553.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002156-----------------------
2157
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002158busy-polling
2159 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2160 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2161 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2162 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2163 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2164 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2165 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2166 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2167 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2168 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2169 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2170 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2171 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2172 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2173 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2174 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2175 "poll" pollers.
2176
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002177 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2178 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2179 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2180
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002181max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002182 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002183 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2184 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2185 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2186 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2187 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2188 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2189 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2190
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002191maxconn <number>
2192 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2193 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2194 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002195 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2196 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2197 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2198 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002199 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2200 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2201 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2202 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2203 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2204 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002205
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002206maxconnrate <number>
2207 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2208 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2209 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2210 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2211 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2212 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2213 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2214 fairness.
2215
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002216maxcomprate <number>
2217 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002218 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002219 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2220 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2221 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002222 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002223 default value.
2224
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002225maxcompcpuusage <number>
2226 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2227 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2228 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002229 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2230 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2231 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2232 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002233
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002234maxpipes <number>
2235 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2236 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2237 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2238 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2239 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2240 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2241
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002242maxsessrate <number>
2243 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2244 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2245 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2246 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2247 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2248 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2249 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2250 fairness.
2251
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002252maxsslconn <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2254 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2255 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2256 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2257 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2258 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2259 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002260 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2261 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2262 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2263 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002264 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002265 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2266 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002267
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002268maxsslrate <number>
2269 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2270 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2271 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2272 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2273 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2274 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2275 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2276 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2277 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2278 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2279
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002280maxzlibmem <number>
2281 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2282 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2283 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002284 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2285 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2286 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2287
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002288noepoll
2289 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2290 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002291 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002292
2293nokqueue
2294 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2295 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2296 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2297
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002298noevports
2299 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2300 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2301 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2302 also "nopoll".
2303
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002304nopoll
2305 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2306 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002308 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2309 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002311nosplice
2312 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002314 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002315 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002316 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2317 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2318 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2319 "option splice-response".
2320
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002321nogetaddrinfo
2322 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2323 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2324
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002325noreuseport
2326 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2327 command line argument "-dR".
2328
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002329profiling.memory { on | off }
2330 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2331 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2332 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2333 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2334 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2335 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2336 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2337 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2338 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2339
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002340profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2341 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2342 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2343 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2344 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002345 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002346 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2347 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2348 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2349 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2350
2351 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2352 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2353 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2354 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2355 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002356 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2357 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2358 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2359 CLI.
2360
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002361spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002362 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2363 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2364 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2365 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2366 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2367 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002368
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002369ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002370 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002371 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002372 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002373 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002374 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2375 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2376 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002377 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2378 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002379 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2380 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2381 openssl configuration file uses:
2382 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2383
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002384ssl-mode-async
2385 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002386 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002387 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2388 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002389 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002390 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002391 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002392
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002393tune.buffers.limit <number>
2394 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2395 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2396 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2397 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2398 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002399 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002400 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2401 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2402 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2403 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2404 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2405 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2406 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2407 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002408 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002409
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002410tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2411 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2412 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2413 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002414 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002415
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002416tune.bufsize <number>
2417 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2418 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2419 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2420 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2421 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2422 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2423 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002424 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2425 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002426 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002427 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002428 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002429 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2430 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002431
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002432tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2433 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2434 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2435 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2436 this value. The default value is 1.
2437
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002438tune.fail-alloc
2439 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2440 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2441 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2442 gracefully.
2443
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002444tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2445 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2446 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2447 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2448 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2449 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2450
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002451tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2452 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2453 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2454 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2455 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2456 change it.
2457
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002458tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2459 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002461 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002462 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2463 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2464 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2465 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2466 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2467
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002468tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2469 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2470 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2471 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2472 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2473 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002474 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002475 recommended not to change this value.
2476
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002477tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002478 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002479 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002480 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002481 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2482 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2483 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2484 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2485
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002486tune.http.cookielen <number>
2487 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2488 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2489 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2490 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2491 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2492 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2493 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2494 to change this value.
2495
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002496tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002497 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2498 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002499 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002501 configuration directives too.
2502 The default value is 1024.
2503
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002504tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2505 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2506 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2507 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2508 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2509 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2510 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002511 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2512 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2513 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002514
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002515tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2516 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2517 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2518 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2519 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2520 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2521 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002522 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2523 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2524 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2525 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2526 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002527
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002528tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002529 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002530 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2531 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2532 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2533 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002534 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002535 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002536 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002537 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2538
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002539tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2540 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2541 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2542 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2543 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2544 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2545 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2546 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2547 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2548 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2549
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002550tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2551 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002552 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002553 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2554 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002555 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002556 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2557 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2558
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002559tune.lua.maxmem
2560 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2561 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2562 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2563 memory.
2564
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002565tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2566 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002567 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2568 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002569 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002570
2571tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2572 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2573 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2574 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2575 check servers.
2576
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002577tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2578 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2579 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2580 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002581 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002582
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002583tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002584 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2585 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002586 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2587 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2588 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2589 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2590 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2591 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2592 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2593 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2594 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002595
2596tune.maxpollevents <number>
2597 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2598 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2599 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2600 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2601 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2602
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002603tune.maxrewrite <number>
2604 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2605 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2606 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2607 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2608 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2609 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2610 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2611 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2612 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2613 bufsize.
2614
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002615tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2616 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2617 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2618 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2619 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2620 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2621 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2622 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2623 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2624 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002625 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2626 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002627 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2628 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2629 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2630 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2631 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2632 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2633 setting this parameter to 0.
2634
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002635tune.pipesize <number>
2636 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2637 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2638 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2639 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2640 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2641 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2642
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002643tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2644 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002645 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002646 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2647 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2648 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2649 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002650 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002651
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002652tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2653 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002654 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002655 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2656 default is 20.
2657
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002658tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2659tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2660 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2661 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2662 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002663 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002665 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2666 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2667
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002668tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002669 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002670 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2671 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2672 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2673 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2674
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002675tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002676 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002677 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2678 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2679 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2680 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2681 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2682 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2683 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002684
2685tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2686 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002687 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002688 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2689 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2690 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2691 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2692 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2693 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2694 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002695
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002696tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2697tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2698 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2699 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2700 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002701 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002702 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002703 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2704 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2705 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2706 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002707 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002708
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002709tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002710 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002711 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2712 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2713 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2714 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2715 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2716 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2717 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2718 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2719 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002720 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2721 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002722
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002723tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002724 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002725 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2726 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2727 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2728 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2729 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2730
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002731tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2732 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2733 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2734 performances. This is disabled by default.
2735
2736 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2737 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2738
2739 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2740
2741 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2742
2743 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2744
2745 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2746 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2747 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2748
2749 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2750 converted.
2751
2752 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2753 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2754 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2755 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2756 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2757 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2758 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002759 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2760 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002761
2762 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2763
2764 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2765 only need this line:
2766
2767 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2768
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002769tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2770 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002771 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002772 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2773 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2774 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2775 being used for too long.
2776
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002777tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2778 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2779 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2780 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2781 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2782 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2783 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2784 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2785 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2786 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2787 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002788 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002789 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002790
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002791tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2792 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2793 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2794 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2795 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002796 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002797 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2798 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002799 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2800 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002801
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002802tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2803 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2804 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2805 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2806 1000 entries.
2807
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002808tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002809 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2810 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2811 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2812 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002813
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002814tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002815tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002816tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2817tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2818tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002819 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2820 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2821 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2822 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2823 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2824 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2825 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2826 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002827
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002828 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2829 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2830 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2831 all available space is consumed.
2832 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2833 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2834 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002835
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002836tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2837 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002838 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002839 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002840 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002841 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2842
2843tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2844 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2845 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002846 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2847 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028493.3. Debugging
2850--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002852quiet
2853 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2854 line argument "-q".
2855
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002856zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002857 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002858 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2859 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2860 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2861 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2862 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2863
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028653.4. Userlists
2866--------------
2867It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2868http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2869it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2870
2871userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002872 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002873 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2874
2875group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002876 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002877 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2878 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2879
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002880user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2881 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002882 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2883 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002884 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2885 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2886 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2887 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002888
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002889 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2890 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2891 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2892 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2893 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2894 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2895 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002896 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002897 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002898
2899 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002900 userlist L1
2901 group G1 users tiger,scott
2902 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002903
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002904 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2905 user scott insecure-password elgato
2906 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002907
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002908 userlist L2
2909 group G1
2910 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002911
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002912 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2913 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2914 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002915
2916 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002917
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002918
29193.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002920----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002921It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002922several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002923instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2924values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2925automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2926In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2927using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2928tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2929reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2930Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2931that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2932each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002933
2934peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002935 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002936 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2937
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002938bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2939 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2940 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2941
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002942disabled
2943 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2944 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2945 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2946
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002947default-bind [param*]
2948 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2949
2950default-server [param*]
2951 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2952
2953 Arguments:
2954 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2955 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2956 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2957 details.
2958
2959
2960 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2961
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002962enable
2963 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2964
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002965log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002966 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2967 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2968 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2969 more details.
2970
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002971peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002972 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2973 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002974 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002975 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002976 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2977 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2978 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002979
2980 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2981 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2982
2983 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002984 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2985 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2986 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002987
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002988 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2989 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002990
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002991 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2992 "server" keyword explanation below).
2993
2994server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002995 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002996 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2997 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2998 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2999 of this "peers" section).
3000 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3001
3002
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003003 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003004 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003005 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003006 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3007 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3008 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009
3010 backend mybackend
3011 mode tcp
3012 balance roundrobin
3013 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3014 stick on src
3015
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003016 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3017 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003018
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003019 Example:
3020 peers mypeers
3021 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3022 default-server ssl verify none
3023 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3024 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003025
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003026
3027table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3028 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3029
3030 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3031 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003032 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003033 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3034 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3035 "stick-table" keyword).
3036
3037 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3038 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3039 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3040 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3041 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3042 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3043 of the stick-table name as follows:
3044
3045 peers mypeers
3046 peer A ...
3047 peer B ...
3048 table t1 ...
3049
3050 frontend fe1
3051 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3052
3053 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3054 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3055
3056 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3057 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3058 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3059 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3060 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3061 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3062 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3063
3064 peers mypeers
3065 peer A ...
3066 peer B ...
3067 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3068
3069 backend t1
3070 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3071
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003072 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003073 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3074 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3075
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030763.6. Mailers
3077------------
3078It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3079If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3080in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3081
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003082mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003083 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3084 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3085
3086mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3087 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3088
3089 Example:
3090 mailers mymailers
3091 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3092 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3093
3094 backend mybackend
3095 mode tcp
3096 balance roundrobin
3097
3098 email-alert mailers mymailers
3099 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3100 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3101
3102 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3103 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3104
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003105timeout mail <time>
3106 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3107 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3108 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3109 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3110
3111 Example:
3112 mailers mymailers
3113 timeout mail 20s
3114 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003115
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031163.7. Programs
3117-------------
3118In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3119master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3120managed the same way as the workers.
3121
3122During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3123sequence as a worker:
3124
3125 - the master is re-executed
3126 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3127 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3128 instance of the program
3129
3130During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3131
3132program <name>
3133 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3134 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3135 the management guide).
3136
3137command <command> [arguments*]
3138 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3139 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3140 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3141 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3142
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003143user <user name>
3144 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3145 See also "group".
3146
3147group <group name>
3148 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3149 See also "user".
3150
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003151option start-on-reload
3152no option start-on-reload
3153 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3154 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3155 program section.
3156
3157
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031583.8. HTTP-errors
3159----------------
3160
3161It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3162imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3163several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3164
3165http-errors <name>
3166 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3167 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3168
3169errorfile <code> <file>
3170 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3171
3172 Arguments :
3173 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003174 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003175 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003176
3177 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3178 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3179 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3180 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3181 before any chroot is performed.
3182
3183 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3184
3185 Example:
3186 http-errors website-1
3187 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3188 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3189 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3190
3191 http-errors website-2
3192 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3193 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3194 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3195
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031963.9. Rings
3197----------
3198
3199It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3200servers or traces.
3201
3202ring <ringname>
3203 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3204
3205description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003206 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003207 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3208
3209format <format>
3210 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3211
3212 Arguments:
3213 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3214 one of the following :
3215
3216 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3217 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3218 designed to be used with a local log server.
3219
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003220 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3221 field is stripped. This is the default.
3222 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3223 rfc3164.
3224
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003225 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3226 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3227 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3228 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3229 is the default.
3230
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003231 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003232 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3233
3234 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3235 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3236
3237 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3238 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3239 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3240 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3241 logger consumes.
3242
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003243 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3244 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3245 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3246 with a local log server.
3247
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003248 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3249 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3250 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3251 used with a local log server.
3252
3253maxlen <length>
3254 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3255 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3256 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3257
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003258server <name> <address> [param*]
3259 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3260 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3261 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3262 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3263 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3264 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3265 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3266 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3267 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003268 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3269 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003270
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003271size <size>
3272 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3273 set to BUFSIZE.
3274
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003275timeout connect <timeout>
3276 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3277
3278 Arguments :
3279 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3281 as explained at the top of this document.
3282
3283timeout server <timeout>
3284 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3285
3286 Arguments :
3287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3289 as explained at the top of this document.
3290
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003291 Example:
3292 global
3293 log ring@myring local7
3294
3295 ring myring
3296 description "My local buffer"
3297 format rfc3164
3298 maxlen 1200
3299 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003300 timeout connect 5s
3301 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003302 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003303
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033043.10. Log forwarding
3305-------------------
3306
3307It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003308HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003309
3310log-forward <name>
3311 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3312
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003313backlog <conns>
3314 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3315 on connections accept.
3316
3317bind <addr> [param*]
3318 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003319 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3320 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3321 syslog protocol over TCP.
3322 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003323 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3324
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003325dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003326 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3327 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3328 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3329 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003330 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003331
3332log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003333log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003334 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3335 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3336 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003337 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003338 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3339 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3340 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003341 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003342
3343 Example:
3344 global
3345 log stderr format iso local7
3346
3347 ring myring
3348 description "My local buffer"
3349 format rfc5424
3350 maxlen 1200
3351 size 32764
3352 timeout connect 5s
3353 timeout server 10s
3354 # syslog tcp server
3355 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3356
3357 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003358 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3359 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003360 # all messages on stderr
3361 log global
3362 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3363 log ring@myring local0
3364 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3365 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3366 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003369
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370maxconn <conns>
3371 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3372 10 is the default.
3373
3374timeout client <timeout>
3375 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033774. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003378----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003381 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3382 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3383 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003385
3386A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3387connections.
3388
3389A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3390to forward incoming connections.
3391
3392A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3393parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3394
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003395A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3396ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3397sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3398the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3399explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3400from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3401"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3402for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3403to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3404optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3405are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3406any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3407names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3408that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3409duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3410names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3411
3412Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3413settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3414of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3415profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3416timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3419'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3420case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3421
3422Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3423logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3424proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3425However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3426name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3427
3428Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3429and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003430bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003431protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3432modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3433arbitrary criteria.
3434
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003435In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3436a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003437the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003438
3439 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3440 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3441 between responses and new requests.
3442
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003443 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3444 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3445 client-facing connection remains open.
3446
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003447 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3448 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003449
3450The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3451frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3452following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003453weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003454
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003457 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3458 ----+-----+-----+----
3459 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3460 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003461 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3462 ----+-----+-----+----
3463 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003464
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003465It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003466only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3467within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003468as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003469content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3471possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003473There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003474first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003476second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3478is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3479new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003480to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003481process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3482already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3483HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3484evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3485one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3486
3487There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3488performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3489tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3490preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3491analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3492HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3493header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3494mitigate this drawback.
3495
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003496There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003497method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3498set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3499in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3500is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3501to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3502above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3503to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3504"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3505frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3506frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3507as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3508upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3509on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3510the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3511upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3512frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3513remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035154.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3516--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003518The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3519limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3520they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3521limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003522marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003523option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003524and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3525with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3526specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003527
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003528
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3530------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3531acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003532backlog X X X -
3533balance X - X X
3534bind - X X -
3535bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536capture cookie - X X -
3537capture request header - X X -
3538capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003539clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3540clitcpka-idle X X X -
3541clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003542compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003543cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003544declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545default-server X - X X
3546default_backend X X X -
3547description - X X X
3548disabled X X X X
3549dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003550email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003551email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003552email-alert mailers X X X X
3553email-alert myhostname X X X X
3554email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003555enabled X X X X
3556errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003557errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003558errorloc X X X X
3559errorloc302 X X X X
3560-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3561errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003562force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003563filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003564fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003565hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003566http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003567http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003568http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003569http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003570http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003571http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003572http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003573http-check set-var X - X X
3574http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003575http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003577http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003578http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003579http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003580id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003581ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003582load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003583log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003584log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003585log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003586log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003587max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003588maxconn X X X -
3589mode X X X X
3590monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591monitor-uri X X X -
3592option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3593option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3594option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3595option allbackups (*) X - X X
3596option checkcache (*) X - X X
3597option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3598option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003599option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3601option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3603option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003604option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3605option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003606option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003607option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003608option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003609option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003610option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3612option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3613option httpchk X - X X
3614option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003615option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003616option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003617option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003618option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003619option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003620option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3621option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3622option logasap (*) X X X -
3623option mysql-check X - X X
3624option nolinger (*) X X X X
3625option originalto X X X X
3626option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003627option pgsql-check X - X X
3628option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003629option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003630option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option smtpchk X - X X
3632option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3633option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3634option splice-request (*) X X X X
3635option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003636option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003637option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3638option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003640option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3642option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3643option tcpka X X X X
3644option tcplog X X X X
3645option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003646external-check command X - X X
3647external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3649rate-limit sessions X X X -
3650redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003652retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003653retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003655server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003656server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003658srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3659srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3660srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003661stats admin - X X X
3662stats auth X X X X
3663stats enable X X X X
3664stats hide-version X X X X
3665stats http-request - X X X
3666stats realm X X X X
3667stats refresh X X X X
3668stats scope X X X X
3669stats show-desc X X X X
3670stats show-legends X X X X
3671stats show-node X X X X
3672stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003673-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3674stick match - - X X
3675stick on - - X X
3676stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003677stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003678stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003679tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003680tcp-check connect X - X X
3681tcp-check expect X - X X
3682tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003683tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003684tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003685tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003686tcp-check set-var X - X X
3687tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003688tcp-request connection - X X -
3689tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003690tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003691tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003692tcp-response content - - X X
3693tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003694timeout check X - X X
3695timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003696timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3699timeout http-request X X X X
3700timeout queue X - X X
3701timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003702timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003703timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003704timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003706unique-id-format X X X -
3707unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003709use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003710use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3712 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003713
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037154.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3716---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003717
3718This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3719
3720
3721acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3722 Declare or complete an access list.
3723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3724 no | yes | yes | yes
3725 Example:
3726 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3727 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3728 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003730 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003731
3732
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003733backlog <conns>
3734 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3736 yes | yes | yes | no
3737 Arguments :
3738 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3739 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003740 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003741
3742 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3743 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3744 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3745 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3746 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3747 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3748 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3749 backlog parameter.
3750
3751 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3752 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3753 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3754
3755 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3756
3757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003758balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003759balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | no | yes | yes
3763 Arguments :
3764 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3765 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3766 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3767 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3768
3769 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3770 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3771 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3772 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003773 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003774 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003775 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3776 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3777 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3778 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3779 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3780 it, so that you don't worry.
3781
3782 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3783 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3784 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3785 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3786 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3787 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3788 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3789 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003791 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3792 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3793 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3794 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3795 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3796 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3797 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003798 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3799 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3800 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003801
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003802 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003803 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003804 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3805 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003806 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003807 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3808 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3809 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3810 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3811 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003812 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3813 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3814 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3815 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3816 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3817 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003819 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3820 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3821 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3822 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3823 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3824 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3825 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3826 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003827 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003828 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003829 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3830 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3831 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003832
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003833 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3834 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3835 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3836 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3837 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3838 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3839 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3840 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3841 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3842 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3843 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3844 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003845
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003846 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003847 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3848 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3849 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3850 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3851 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3852 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3853 URIs start with a leading "/".
3854
3855 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3856 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3857 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3858 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3859
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003860 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3861 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3862 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3863 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3864
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003865 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003866 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3867
3868 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003869 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3870 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003871 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3872 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3873 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3874 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003875 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003876 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3877 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003878
3879 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3880 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3881 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3882 server will receive the request.
3883
3884 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3885 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3886 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3887 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3888 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003889 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3890 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3891 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003892
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003893 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3894 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3895 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3896 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3897 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003899 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003900 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3901 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3902 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3903
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003904 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3905 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3906 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3907
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003908 random
3909 random(<draws>)
3910 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003911 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3912 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3913 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3914 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003915 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3916 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3917 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3918 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3919 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3920 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3921 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3922 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3923 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3924 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3925 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3926 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3927 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3928 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3929 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3930 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3931 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3932 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3933 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3934 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003935
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003936 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003937 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003938 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3939 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3940 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3941 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3942 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3943 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003944 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003945 used instead.
3946
3947 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3948 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3949 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3950 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3951
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003952 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3953 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3954 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3955
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003956 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003957
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003958 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003959 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3960 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003961
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003962 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3963 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3964 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003966 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003967 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003968 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3969 NTLM relies on.
3970
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003971 Examples :
3972 balance roundrobin
3973 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003974 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003975 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3976 balance hdr(host)
3977 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003978
3979 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3980 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3981
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003982 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003983 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3984 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3985 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003986 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003987
3988 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3989 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3990 defaults to 16 kB.
3991
3992 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3993 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3994
3995 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3996 Round Robin.
3997
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003998 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003999 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4000 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4001 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4002
4003 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4004
4005 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004006 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004007 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4008 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4009 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004011 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004012
4013
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004014bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4015bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004016 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 no | yes | yes | no
4019 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004020 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4021 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4022 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4023 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004024 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004025 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4026 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4027 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4028 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4029 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4030 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004031 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004032 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4033 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004034 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004035 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4036 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004037 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004038 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4039 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004040 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004041 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004042 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4043 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4044 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004045 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4046 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4047 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4048 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004049 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4050 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4051 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004052
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004053 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4054 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004055 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4056 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4057 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004058 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4059 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4060 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4061 the range.
4062
4063 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4064 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4065 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4066 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4067 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4068 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4069 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004070 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004071 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004073 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004074 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004075 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4076 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4077 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4078 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4079 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4080 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004082 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4083 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4084 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4085 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4088 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4089 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4090 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4091 in a frontend.
4092
4093 Example :
4094 listen http_proxy
4095 bind :80,:443
4096 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004097 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004098
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004099 listen http_https_proxy
4100 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004101 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004103 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4104 bind ipv6@:80
4105 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4106 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4107
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004108 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004109 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004110
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004111 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4112 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4113 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4114 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4115 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4116
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004117 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004118 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004119
4120
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004121bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004124
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004125 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4126 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4127 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4128 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4129 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4130 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004131
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004132 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004133
4134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135capture cookie <name> len <length>
4136 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4138 no | yes | yes | no
4139 Arguments :
4140 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4141 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4142 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4143 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004144 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004145
4146 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4147 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4148 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4149 right if it exceeds <length>.
4150
4151 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4152 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4153 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4154 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4155
4156 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4157 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4158 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4159
4160 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4161 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4162 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004163 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4164 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4165 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004166
4167 Example:
4168 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4169
4170 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004171 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004172
4173
4174capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004175 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4177 no | yes | yes | no
4178 Arguments :
4179 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004180 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004181 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4182 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4183 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4184
4185 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4186 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4187 it exceeds <length>.
4188
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004189 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004190 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4191 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004192 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4193 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4194 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4195 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004196 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004197 environments to find where the request came from.
4198
4199 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4200 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4201 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4202 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004203
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004204 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4205 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4206 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4207 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4208 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004209
4210 Example:
4211 capture request header Host len 15
4212 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004213 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004215 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004216 about logging.
4217
4218
4219capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004220 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4222 no | yes | yes | no
4223 Arguments :
4224 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004225 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004226 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4227 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4228 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4229
4230 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4231 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4232 it exceeds <length>.
4233
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004234 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004235 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4236 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4237 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004238 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4239 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4240 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4241 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004243 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4244 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4245 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4246 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4247 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004248
4249 Example:
4250 capture response header Content-length len 9
4251 capture response header Location len 15
4252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004254 about logging.
4255
4256
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004257clitcpka-cnt <count>
4258 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4259 the connection on the client side.
4260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4261 yes | yes | yes | no
4262 Arguments :
4263 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4264
4265 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4266 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004267 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4268 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004269
4270 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4271
4272
4273clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4274 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4275 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4276 client side.
4277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 yes | yes | yes | no
4279 Arguments :
4280 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4281 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4282 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4283 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4284
4285 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4286 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004287 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4288 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004289
4290 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4291
4292
4293clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4294 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 yes | yes | yes | no
4297 Arguments :
4298 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4299 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4300 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4301 document.
4302
4303 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4304 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004305 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4306 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004307
4308 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4309
4310
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004311compression algo <algorithm> ...
4312compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004313compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004314 Enable HTTP compression.
4315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 yes | yes | yes | yes
4317 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004318 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4319 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004320 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004321
4322 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004323 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4324 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4325 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004326
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004327 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004328 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004329
4330 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4331 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4332 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4333 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4334 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004335 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004336
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004337 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4338 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4339 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4340 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4341 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4342 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4343 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004344 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004345
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004346 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004347 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004348 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004349 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004350 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004351 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004352 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004353
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004354 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004355 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4356 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004357 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4358 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004359 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004360 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004361 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4362 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004363 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004364 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4365 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004366
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004367 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004368 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4369 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004370 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004371 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004372 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4373 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4374 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4375 "multipart"
4376 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4377 header
4378 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4379 and later
4380 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4381 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004382 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004383
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004384 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004385
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004386 Examples :
4387 compression algo gzip
4388 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004389
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004390
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004391cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004392 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4393 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004394 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004395 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | no | yes | yes
4398 Arguments :
4399 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4400 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4401 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4402 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4403 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4404 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004405 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004406 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4407 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4408
4409 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004410 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004411 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4412 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4413 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4414 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004415 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4416 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004417 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004418 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4419 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004420
4421 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004422 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004423
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004424 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004425 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004426 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004427 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004428 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4429 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4430 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4431 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4432 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4433 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4434 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004435
4436 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4437 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4438 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4439 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4440 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4441 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4442 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4443 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4444 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004445 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004446 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4447 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4448 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004449
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004450 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4451 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4452 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004453 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4454 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4455 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4456 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004457 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4458 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4459 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004460
4461 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4462 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4463 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4464 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4465 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4466 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4467 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4468 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4469 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4470
4471 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4472 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4473 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4474 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4475 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4476 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4477 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4478 persistence cookie in the cache.
4479 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4480
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004481 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4482 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004483 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004484 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4485 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004486 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004487 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4488 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4489 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4490 they logout.
4491
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004492 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004493 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4494 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4495 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4496
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004497 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004498 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4499 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4500 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4501 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4502 this attribute.
4503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004504 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004505 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004506 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4507 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4508 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4509 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4510 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4511 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004512
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004513 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4514 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4515 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4516 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4517 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4518 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4519 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4520 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004521 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004522 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4523 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4524 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4525 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4526 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4527 the site.
4528
4529 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4530 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4531 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4532 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4533 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4534 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4535 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4536 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4537 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4538 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4539 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4540 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4541 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004542 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004543 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4544 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4545
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004546 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4547 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4548 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4549 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4550 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4551 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4552
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004553 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004554 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4555 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4556 repeated.
4557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004558 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4559 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4560 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4561 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004563 Examples :
4564 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4565 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4566 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004567 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004568
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004569 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004571
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004572declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4573 Declares a capture slot.
4574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4575 no | yes | yes | no
4576 Arguments:
4577 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4578
4579 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4580 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4581 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4582 for use in the response.
4583
4584 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004585 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004586 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4587
4588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004589default-server [param*]
4590 Change default options for a server in a backend
4591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4592 yes | no | yes | yes
4593 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004594 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4595 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4596 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4597 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004598
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004599 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004600 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4601
4602 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004603
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605default_backend <backend>
4606 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | yes | yes | no
4609 Arguments :
4610 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4611
4612 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4613 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4614 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4615 will catch all undetermined requests.
4616
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617 Example :
4618
4619 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4620 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4621 default_backend dynamic
4622
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004623 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004624
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004625
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004626description <string>
4627 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4629 no | yes | yes | yes
4630 Arguments : string
4631
4632 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4633 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4634 it describes.
4635 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4636
4637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638disabled
4639 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4641 yes | yes | yes | yes
4642 Arguments : none
4643
4644 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4645 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4646 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4647 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4648 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4649 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4650 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4651
4652 See also : "enabled"
4653
4654
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004655dispatch <address>:<port>
4656 Set a default server address
4657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4658 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004659 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004660
4661 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4662 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4663 during start-up.
4664
4665 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4666 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4667 possible with normal servers.
4668
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004669 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004670 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4671 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4672 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4673 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4674
4675 See also : "server"
4676
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004677
4678dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4679 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 yes | no | yes | yes
4682 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4683
4684 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004685 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004686 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4687 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004688 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004689 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004691enabled
4692 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | yes | yes | yes
4695 Arguments : none
4696
4697 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4698 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4699
4700 See also : "disabled"
4701
4702
4703errorfile <code> <file>
4704 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4706 yes | yes | yes | yes
4707 Arguments :
4708 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004709 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004710 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711
4712 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004713 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004715 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4716 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717
4718 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4719 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4720 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4721
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004722 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4723
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004724 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4725 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4726 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4727 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4728 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4729 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4730 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4731 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4732 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004733
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4735 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4736 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004737 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4739
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004740 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004742 Example :
4743 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004744 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004745 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4746 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4747
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004748
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004749errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4750 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4751 section.
4752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 yes | yes | yes | yes
4754 Arguments :
4755 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4756
4757 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004758 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004759 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4760 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004761
4762 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4763 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4764 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4765 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4766 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004767 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004768 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4769
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004770 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4771 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004772
4773 Example :
4774 errorfiles generic
4775 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4776
4777
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004778errorloc <code> <url>
4779errorloc302 <code> <url>
4780 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 yes | yes | yes | yes
4783 Arguments :
4784 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004785 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004786 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004787
4788 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4789 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4790 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4791 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004792 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004793
4794 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4795 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4796 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4797
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004798 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4799
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004800 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4801 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4802 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4803 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004804 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004805 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4806 request.
4807
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004808 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004809
4810
4811errorloc303 <code> <url>
4812 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | yes | yes | yes
4815 Arguments :
4816 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004817 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004818 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004819
4820 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4821 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4822 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4823 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004824 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004825
4826 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4827 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4828 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4829
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004830 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4833 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4834 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4835 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004836 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004837
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004838 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004839
4840
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004841email-alert from <emailaddr>
4842 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004843 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4845 yes | yes | yes | yes
4846
4847 Arguments :
4848
4849 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4850
4851 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4852 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4853
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004854 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004855 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4856 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004857
4858
4859email-alert level <level>
4860 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4861 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | yes | yes | yes
4864
4865 Arguments :
4866
4867 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4868 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4869 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4870
4871 By default level is alert
4872
4873 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4874 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4875 for the proxy.
4876
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004877 Alerts are sent when :
4878
4879 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4880 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4881 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4882 is notice or lower
4883 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4884 and a health check status update occurs
4885
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004886 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4887 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004888 section 3.6 about mailers.
4889
4890
4891email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4892 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4894 yes | yes | yes | yes
4895
4896 Arguments :
4897
4898 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4899
4900 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4901 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4902
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004903 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4904 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004905
4906
4907email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4908 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4909 mailers.
4910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4911 yes | yes | yes | yes
4912
4913 Arguments :
4914
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004915 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004916
4917 By default the systems hostname is used.
4918
4919 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4920 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4921 for the proxy.
4922
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004923 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4924 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004925
4926
4927email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004928 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004929 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | yes | yes | yes
4932
4933 Arguments :
4934
4935 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4936
4937 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4938 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4939
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004940 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004941 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4942
4943
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004944force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4945 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4946 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004947 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004948
4949 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4950 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4951 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4952 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4953 marked down for maintenance operations.
4954
4955 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4956 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4957 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4958 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4959 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4960 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4961 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4962 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4963 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4964
4965 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4966 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4967 is used.
4968
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004969 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004970 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004971
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004972
4973filter <name> [param*]
4974 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4976 no | yes | yes | yes
4977 Arguments :
4978 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4979 referenced in section 9.
4980
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004981 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004982 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004983 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4984 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004985
4986 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4987 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4988
4989 Example:
4990 listen
4991 bind *:80
4992
4993 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4994 filter compression
4995 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4996
4997 compression algo gzip
4998 compression offload
4999
5000 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5001
5002 See also : section 9.
5003
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005004
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005005fullconn <conns>
5006 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5008 yes | no | yes | yes
5009 Arguments :
5010 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5011 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5012
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005013 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005014 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005015 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5017 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5018 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5019 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5020 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005021 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005023 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005024 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005025 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5026 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5027 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005029 Example :
5030 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5031 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5032 # connections.
5033 backend dynamic
5034 fullconn 10000
5035 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5036 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5037
5038 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5039
5040
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005041hash-balance-factor <factor>
5042 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5044 yes | no | no | yes
5045 Arguments :
5046 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5047 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005048 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005049
5050 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5051 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5052 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5053 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5054 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5055 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5056 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5057
5058 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5059 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5060 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5061 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5062 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5063
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005064 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5065 consistent hashing mechanism.
5066
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005067 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5068
5069
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005070hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005071 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5073 yes | no | yes | yes
5074 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005075 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5076 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005077
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005078 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5079 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5080 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5081 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5082 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5083 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5084 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5085 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5086 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5087 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005088
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005089 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5090 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5091 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5092 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5093 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5094 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5095 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5096 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5097 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5098 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5099 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5100 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5101 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005102 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5103 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005104
5105 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5106
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005107 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005108 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5109 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5110 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005111 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5112 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5113 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005114
5115 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5116 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005117 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5118 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5119 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5120 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5121
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005122 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005123 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5124 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5125 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5126 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5127 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5128 parameter.
5129
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005130 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5131 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5132 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5133 used on strings.
5134
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005135 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5136
5137 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5138 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5139 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5140 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5141 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5142 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5143 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5144 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5145 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5146 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5147 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5148 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005149
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005150 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5151 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5152 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005153
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005154 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005155
5156
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005157http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5158 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5159 ones).
5160
5161 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 no | yes | yes | yes
5163
5164 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5165 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5166 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5167 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5168 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5169 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5170
5171 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5172 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5173 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5174
5175 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5176 below.
5177
5178 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5179 instance.
5180
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005181 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5182 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5183 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5184
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005185 Example:
5186 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5187 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5188 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5189
5190http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5191
5192 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5193 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5194 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5195 example, or to pass some internal information.
5196 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5197 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5198 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5199
5200http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5201
5202 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5203 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5204
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005205http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005206
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005207 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5208 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5209 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5210 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5211 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005212
5213http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5214 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5215
5216 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5217
5218 Example:
5219 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5220
5221 # applied to:
5222 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5223
5224 # outputs:
5225 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5226
5227 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5228
5229http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5230 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5231
5232 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5233
5234 Example:
5235 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5236
5237 # applied to:
5238 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5239
5240 # outputs:
5241 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5242
5243http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5244
5245 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5246 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5247 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5248
5249http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5250 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5251
5252 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5253 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5254 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5255 fallback.
5256
5257 Example:
5258 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5259 http-response set-status 431
5260 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5261 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5262
5263http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5264
5265 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5266 inline.
5267
5268 Arguments:
5269 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5270 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5271 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5272 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5273 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5274 (request and response)
5275 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5276 processing
5277 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5278 processing
5279 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5280 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5281 and '_'.
5282
5283 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5284 followed by some converters.
5285
5286 Example:
5287 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5288
5289http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5290
5291 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5292 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5293 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5294 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5295 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005296 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005297 processing.
5298
5299 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5300 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005301 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005302 rules evaluation.
5303
5304http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305
5306 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5307 details about <var-name>.
5308
5309 Example:
5310 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5311
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005312
5313http-check comment <string>
5314 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5315 it fails.
5316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5317 yes | no | yes | yes
5318
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005319 Arguments :
5320 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5321 rule fails.
5322
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005323 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5324 user-friendly error reporting.
5325
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005326 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005327 "http-check expect".
5328
5329
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005330http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5331 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005332 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005333 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5335 yes | no | yes | yes
5336
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005337 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005338 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5339
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005340 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005341 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005342
5343 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5344 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5345 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5346 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5347
5348 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5349
5350 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5351
5352 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5353
5354 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5355
5356 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5357
5358 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5359 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5360 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5361 is used.
5362
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005363 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5364 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5365 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5366 haproxy -vv.
5367
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005368 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5369
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005370 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5371 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5372 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5373 different ports or with different servers.
5374
5375 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5376 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5377 the port with a "http-check connect".
5378
5379 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5380 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5381 do.
5382
5383 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5384 unset-var or comment rules.
5385
5386 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005387 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5388 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5389 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5390 option httpchk
5391
5392 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005393 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005394 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005395 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005396 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005397 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005398
5399 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5400
5401 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005402
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005404http-check disable-on-404
5405 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005407 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005408 Arguments : none
5409
5410 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5411 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5412 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5413 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5414 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5415 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5416 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5417 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005418 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5419 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005420 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5421 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5422 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005423
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005424 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005425
5426
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005427http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005428 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5429 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5430 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005431 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005433 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005434
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005435 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005436 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5437
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005438 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5439 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5440 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5441 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5442 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5443 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5444 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5445 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5446 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5447 result is always conclusive.
5448
5449 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5450 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5451 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005452 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5453 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005454 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5455 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005456 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5457 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5458 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459
5460 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5461 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005462 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5463 supported :
5464 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5465 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005466 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5467 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5468 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5469 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5470 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005471
5472 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5473 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005474 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5475 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5476 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5477 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005478 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5479
5480 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5481 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5482 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5483 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5484
5485 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5486 informational message reported in logs if an error
5487 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5488 log-format string.
5489
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005490 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005491 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5492 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5494 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5495 details on the supported keywords.
5496
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005497 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5498 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5499 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5500 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005501
5502 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5503 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5504 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5505 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5506 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5507
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005508 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5509 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5510 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5511 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5512 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5513 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5514 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005515
5516 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005517 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005518 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5519 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5520 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5521 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5522
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005523 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5524 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005525 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5526 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5527 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5528 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5529 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5530 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5531 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5532 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005533 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5534 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5535 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5536 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5537 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5538 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5539 insensitive on the header names.
5540
5541 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5542 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5543 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5544 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5545 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5546 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005547
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005549 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5551 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5552 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5553 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5554 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005555 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005556 trace).
5557
5558 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005559 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5561 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5562 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5563 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5564 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005565 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005566
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005567 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5568 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5569 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5570 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5571 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5572 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5573
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005574 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005575 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005576 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5577 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5578 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5579 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5580 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5581 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5582
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005583 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5584 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5585 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5586 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5587 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005588
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005589 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5590 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5591
5592 Examples :
5593 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005594 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005595
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005596 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5597 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5598
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005599 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005600 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005601
5602 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005603 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005604
5605 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005606 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005607
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005608 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005609 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005610
5611
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005612http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005613 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5614 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005615 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5616 health checks.
5617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5618 yes | no | yes | yes
5619 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005620 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5621
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005622 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5623 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5624 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5625 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5626 to invent non-standard ones.
5627
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005628 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5629 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5630 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5631 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5632
5633 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5634 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5635 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5636 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005637
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005638 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005639 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005640 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005641 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5642 to add it.
5643
5644 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5645 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5646 to the log-format rules.
5647
5648 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5649 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5650 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005651
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005652 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5653 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5654 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5655 request.
5656
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005657 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5658 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5659 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005660 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5661 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5662 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5663 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005664 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005665
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005666 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005667 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5668 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005669
5670 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5671 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5672 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5673 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5674 configured request authority.
5675
5676 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5677 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005679 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005680
5681
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005682http-check send-state
5683 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5685 yes | no | yes | yes
5686 Arguments : none
5687
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005688 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005689 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005690 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5691 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5692 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005693
5694 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5695 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5696 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5697 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5698 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005699 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5700 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5701 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5702
5703 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5704 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5705 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5706
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005707 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5708 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5709 checked in multiple backends.
5710
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005711 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005712 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5713
5714 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5715 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5716 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5717 one fails.
5718
5719 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5720 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5721 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5722
5723 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5724 server's queue.
5725
5726 Example of a header received by the application server :
5727 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5728 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5729
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005730 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5731 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733
5734http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005735 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005736 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 yes | no | yes | yes
5738
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005739 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005740 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5741 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5744 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5746 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5747 and '-'.
5748
5749 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005751 Examples :
5752 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005753
5754
5755http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 yes | no | yes | yes
5759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5762 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5763 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5764 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5765 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5767 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5768 and '-'.
5769
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005770 Examples :
5771 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005773
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005774http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5775 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5776 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5777 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5778 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 yes | yes | yes | yes
5781 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005782 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005783 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005784 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005785 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005786
5787 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5788 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5789 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5790 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5791
5792 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5793 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5794 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5795 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5796
5797 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5798 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5799 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5800 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5801 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5802 chroot is performed.
5803
5804 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5805 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5806 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5807 considered.
5808
5809 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5810 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5811 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5812 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5813 considered as a raw string.
5814
5815 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5816 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5817 "content-type".
5818
5819 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5820 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5821 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5822 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5823 evaluated as a log-format string.
5824
5825 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5826 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5827 argument to "content-type".
5828
5829 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5830 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5831 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5832 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5833
5834 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5835 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5836 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5837 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5838 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5839 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5840 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5841 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5842
5843 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5844 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5845 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5846
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005847 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5848 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5849 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5850 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5851 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5852
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005853 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5854 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5855
5856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005858 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5859
5860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5861 no | yes | yes | yes
5862
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005863 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5864 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5865 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5866 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5867 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005868
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005869 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5870 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005872 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874 Example:
5875 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5876 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5877 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005879 http-request allow if nagios
5880 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5881 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5882 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 Example:
5885 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5886 acl add path /addacl
5887 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005889 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5892 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005893
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005894 Example:
5895 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5896 acl setmap path /setmap
5897 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005898
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005899 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5902 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005903
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005904 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5905 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005907http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5910 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5911 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5912 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5913 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5914 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5915 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5916 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005918http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5921 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5922 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5923 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5924 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5925 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5926 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5927 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005928
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005929http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005930
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005931 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5932 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005933
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005934
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005935http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5938 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5939 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5940 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5941 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005942
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005943 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5944 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5945 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5946 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5947 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5948 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5949 instead.
5950
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005951 Example:
5952 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5953 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005955http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005956
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005957 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005958
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005959http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5960 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5963 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5964 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5965 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5966 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5967 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5968 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5969 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5970 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005972 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5973 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5974 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005975 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5976
5977 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5978 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5979 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5980 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005984 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5985 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5986 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5987 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5988 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5989 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005990
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005991http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005992
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005993 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5994 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5995 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5996 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5997 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006001 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6002 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6003 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6004 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6005 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6006 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006007
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006008http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6009http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6010 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6011 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6012 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6013 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006014
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006015 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6016 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6017 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006018 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006019 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6020 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6021 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006023 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006024
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006025http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6026 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6027 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6028 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6029
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006030http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6031
6032 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6033 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6034 pointed by <resolvers>.
6035 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6036 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6037 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6038 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6039 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6040 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6041 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6042 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6043 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6044 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6045 to 0.0.0.0.
6046
6047 Example:
6048 resolvers mydns
6049 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6050 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6051 timeout retry 1s
6052 hold valid 10s
6053 hold nx 3s
6054 hold other 3s
6055 hold obsolete 0s
6056 accepted_payload_size 8192
6057
6058 frontend fe
6059 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6060 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6061 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6062
6063 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6064 # which mean DNS resolution error
6065 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6066
6067 default_backend be
6068
6069 backend b_503
6070 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6071 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6072 # 503 error page to end users
6073
6074 backend be
6075 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6076 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6077 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6078 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6079 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6080
6081 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6082 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6083
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006084http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6085
6086 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6087 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6088 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6089 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006090 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6091 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006092
6093 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6094
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006095http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006096http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006097http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006098http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006099http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006100http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006101http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006102http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6103http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006104
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006105 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6106
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006107 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006108 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6109 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6110 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6111 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006112
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006113 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6114 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6115 the supported backend.
6116
6117 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6118 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6119 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6120 number of segments in the path.
6121
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006122 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6123 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6124 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6125 when improperly combined.
6126
6127 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6128 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6129 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6130 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6131 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6132
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006133 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006134
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006135 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6136
6137 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6138 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6139
6140 Example:
6141 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6142
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006143 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6144
6145 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6146 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6147
6148 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6149 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6150
6151 Example:
6152 - /#foo -> /
6153
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006154 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6155 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006156
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006157 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6158 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6159
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006160 Example:
6161 - /. -> /
6162 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6163 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6164 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006165
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006166 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6167 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6168
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006169 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006170 their preceding segment.
6171
6172 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6173 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6174
6175 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6176 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006177
6178 Example:
6179 - /foo/../ -> /
6180 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6181 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6182 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006183 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006184 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006185 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006186
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006187 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6188 removed as well:
6189
6190 Example:
6191 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6192 - /bar/../../ -> /
6193
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006194 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6195 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006196
6197 Example:
6198 - // -> /
6199 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6200
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006201 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6202 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6203
6204 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6205 ".", "_", and "~".
6206
6207 Example:
6208 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6209 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6210 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6211 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6212
6213 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6214 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6215
6216 Example:
6217 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6218 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6219
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006220 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006221 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006222
6223 Example:
6224 - /%6f -> /%6F
6225 - /%zz -> /%zz
6226
6227 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6228 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6229
6230 Example:
6231 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6232
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006233 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006234 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6235 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6236
6237 Example:
6238 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6239 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6240 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006242http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006244 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6245 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6246 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6247 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6248 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006250http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6253 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6254 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6255 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006256
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006257http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6258 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006259
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006260 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006261 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6262 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6263 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6264 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6265 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006266
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006267 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6268 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6269 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6270 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6271 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006272
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006273 Example:
6274 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6275
6276 # applied to:
6277 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6278
6279 # outputs:
6280 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6281
6282 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006283
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006284 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6285
6286 # applied to:
6287 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006288
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006289 # outputs:
6290 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006291
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006292http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6294
6295 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6296 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006297 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6298 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6299 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006300
6301 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6302 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6303 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6304
6305 Example:
6306 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6307 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6308
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006309 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6310 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6311 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6312 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6313
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006314http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6315 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6316
6317 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6318 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6319 query-string are replaced.
6320
6321 Example:
6322 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6323 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6324
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006325http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6326 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6327
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006328 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6329 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6330 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6331 against.
6332
6333 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6334 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6335 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006336
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006337 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6338 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6339 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6340 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6341 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6342 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6343 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6344 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6345 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006346 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6347 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006348
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006349 Example:
6350 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6351 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006352
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006353 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6354 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006358
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006359 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6360 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6361 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6362 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006363
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006364 Example:
6365 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006366
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006367 # applied to:
6368 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006369
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006370 # outputs:
6371 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006372
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006373http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6374 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6375 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006376 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6378
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006379 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006380 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6381 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006382 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006383 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006384 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006385 are followed to create the response :
6386
6387 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6388 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6389 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6390 ignored.
6391
6392 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6393 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006394 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006395 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6396 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006397
6398 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6399 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6400 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006401 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006402 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006403
6404 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6405 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6406 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006407 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006408 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006409 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006410
6411 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6412 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6413 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6414 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6415 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6416 as a raw content.
6417
6418 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6419 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6420 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6421 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6422 considered as a raw string.
6423
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006424 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006425 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6426 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6427 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6428
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006429 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6430 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006431 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006432
6433 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6434
6435 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006436 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006437 if { path /ping }
6438
6439 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6440 if { path /favicon.ico }
6441
6442 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6443 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6444 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6445
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006446http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6447
6448 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6449 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6450 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6451 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6452 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6453 at this index.
6454 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6455 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6456
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006457http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6458http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006460 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6461 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6462 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006463
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006464http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6465 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6466 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6467 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6468 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6469 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6470 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6471 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6472 at this index.
6473 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6474 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6475
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006476http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006478
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006479 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6480 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6481 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6482 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006484http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006485
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006486 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6487 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6488 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6489 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6490 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006491
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006492 Arguments:
6493 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6494 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006496 Example:
6497 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6498 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006500 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6501 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006503http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6506 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6507 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006509 Arguments:
6510 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6511 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 Example:
6514 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6515 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6518 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6519 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006521http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006523 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6524 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6525 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6526 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6527 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006529 Example:
6530 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6531 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6532 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6533 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6534 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6535 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6536 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6537 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6538 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006540http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6543 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6544 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6545 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6546 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006548http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6549 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006550
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006551 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6552 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6553 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6554 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6555 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6556 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6557 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6558 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6559 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006562
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006563 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6564 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6565 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6566 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6567 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6568 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6569 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006570 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6571 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006572
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006573http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6576 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6577 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006581 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6582 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6583 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6584 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6585 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6586 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6587 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6588 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6593 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6594 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6595 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6596 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6597 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Example :
6600 # prepend the host name before the path
6601 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006602
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006603http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6604
6605 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6606 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6607 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6612 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6613 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6614 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6615 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6620 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6621 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6622 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6623 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6624 values have higher priority.
6625 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6626 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6627 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6628 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6629 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6634 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6635 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6636 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6637 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6638 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6639 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006641 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006642
6643 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6645 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6648 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6649 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6650 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006651 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6652 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653
6654 Arguments :
6655 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6656 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006657
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006658 See also "option forwardfor".
6659
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006660 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006661 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6662 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6663
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006664 # After the masking this will track connections
6665 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6666 http-request track-sc0 src
6667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6669 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6670
6671http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6672
6673 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6674 expression.
6675
6676 Arguments:
6677 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6678 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006679
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006680 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6682 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6683
6684 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6685 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6686 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6687
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006688http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006689 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6690
6691 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6692 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6693 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6694 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6695 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6696
6697 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6698 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6699 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6700 results.
6701
6702 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006703 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6704 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6707
6708 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6709 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6710 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6711 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6712 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6713 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6714 information from the request.
6715
6716 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6717
6718http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6719
6720 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6721 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6722 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6723 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6724 path and the query string.
6725 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6726
6727http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6728
6729 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6730 inline.
6731
6732 Arguments:
6733 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6734 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6737 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6738 (request and response)
6739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6740 processing
6741 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6742 processing
6743 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6744 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6745 and '_'.
6746
6747 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6748 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006749
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006750 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006751 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006753http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6754 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6757 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6758 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6759 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6760 agent name must be used.
6761
6762 Arguments:
6763 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6764
6765 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6766 configuration.
6767
6768http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6769
6770 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6771 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6772 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6773 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6774 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6775 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6776 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6777 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6778 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6779 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6780 action.
6781 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6782 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6783 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6784 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6785 you fully understand how it works.
6786
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006787http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6788
6789 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6790 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6791 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6792 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6793 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006794 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006795 processing.
6796
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006797 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006798 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6799 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6800 rules evaluation.
6801
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006802http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6803http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6804 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6805 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6806 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6807 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006808
6809 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6810 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6811 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006812 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6813 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6814 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6815 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6816 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6817 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006818 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006819 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6820 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6821 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006822 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006823 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6824 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6825 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6826 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6827 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006828
6829http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6830http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6831http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6832
6833 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6834 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6835 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6836 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006837 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006838 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6839 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6840 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6841 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6842 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6843 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6844 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6845
6846 Arguments :
6847 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6848 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6849 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6850 select which table entry to update the counters.
6851
6852 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6853 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6854 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6855 that table until the session ends.
6856
6857 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6858 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6859 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6860 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6861 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6862 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6863 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6864 useful information.
6865
6866 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6867 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6868 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6869 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6870 checks that make use of it.
6871
6872http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6873
6874 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006875
6876 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006877 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006878
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006879http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6880
6881 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6882 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6883 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6884 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6885 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6886 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6887
6888 Arguments :
6889 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6890
6891 Example:
6892 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6893
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006894http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6895 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6896
6897 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6898 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6899 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6900 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6901 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6902 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6903 http-buffer-request".
6904
6905 Arguments :
6906
6907 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6908 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6909
6910 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006911 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006912 bytes.
6913
6914 Example:
6915 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6916
6917 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6918
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006919http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006920
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006921 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6922 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6923 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006924
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006926http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006927 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6928
6929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6930 no | yes | yes | yes
6931
6932 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6933 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6934 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6935 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6936 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6937 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006939 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6940 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006941
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006942 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 Example:
6945 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6950 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006952 Example:
6953 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006955 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006957 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6958 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6961 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006963http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006965 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6966 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6967 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6968 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6969 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6970 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6971 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6972 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006974http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6977 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6978 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6979 example, or to pass some internal information.
6980 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6981 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6982 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6987 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006988
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006989http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006990
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006991 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006992
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006993http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006995 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6996 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6997 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6998 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6999 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7000 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7001 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007002
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007003 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7004 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7005 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7006 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7007 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007008
7009 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7010 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7011 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7012 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7017 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7018 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7019 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7020 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7021 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007022
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007023http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007024
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007025 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7026 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7027 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7028 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7029 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7034 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7035 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7036 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7037 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7038 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007039
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007040http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7041http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7042 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7043 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7044 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7045 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007046
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007047 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7048 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7049 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007050 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007051 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7052 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7053 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007054 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007055 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7060 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7061 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7062 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7063 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7064 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7067 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007068
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007069 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7070 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 Example:
7073 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 # applied to:
7076 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078 # outputs:
7079 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007085
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007086 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007087 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 Example:
7090 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092 # applied to:
7093 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007095 # outputs:
7096 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007097
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007098http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7099 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7100 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007101 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007102 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7103
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007104 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007105 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7106 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007107 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007108 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007109 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007110 are followed to create the response :
7111
7112 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7113 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7114 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7115 ignored.
7116
7117 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7118 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007119 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007120 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7121 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007122
7123 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7124 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7125 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007126 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007127 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007128
7129 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7130 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7131 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007132 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007133 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007134 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007135
7136 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7137 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7138 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7139 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7140 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7141 as a raw content.
7142
7143 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7144 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7145 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7146 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7147 considered as a raw string.
7148
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007149 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7150 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7151 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7152 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7153
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007154 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7155 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007156 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007157
7158 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7159
7160 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007161 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007162 if { status eq 404 }
7163
7164 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7165 string "This is the end !" \
7166 if { status eq 500 }
7167
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007168http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7169
7170 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7171 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7172 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7173 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7174 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7175 at this index.
7176 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7177 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7180http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7183 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7184 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007185
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007186http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7187 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7188
7189 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7190 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7191 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7192 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7193 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7194 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7195 at this index.
7196 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7197 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7198
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007199http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7200 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007201
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007202 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7203 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7204 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7205 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007206
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007207http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007210 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7211 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7212 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7213 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7214 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007215
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007216 Arguments:
7217 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007218
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007219 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7220 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007221
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007222http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007223
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007224 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7225 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7226 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007228http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7229
7230 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7231 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7232 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7233 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7234 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7235
7236http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7237
7238 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7239 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7240 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7241 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7242 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7243 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7244 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7245 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7246 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7247
7248http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7249
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007250 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7251 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7252 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7253 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7254 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7255 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7256 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007257 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7258 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007259
7260http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7261
7262 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7263 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7264 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7265 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7266 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7267 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7268 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7269 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7270
7271http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7273
7274 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7275 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7276 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7277 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007278
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007279 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7281 http-response set-status 431
7282 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7283 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007284
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007285http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7288 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7289 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7290 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7291 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7292 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7293 based on some information from the request.
7294
7295 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7296
7297http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298
7299 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7300 inline.
7301
7302 Arguments:
7303 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7304 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7305 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7306 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7307 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7308 (request and response)
7309 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7310 processing
7311 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7312 processing
7313 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7314 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7315 and '_'.
7316
7317 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7318 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007319
7320 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007321 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007323http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007324
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007325 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7326 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7327 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7328 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7329 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7330 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7331 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7332 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7333 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7334 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7335 action.
7336 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7337 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7338 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7339 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7340 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007341
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007342http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7343
7344 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7345 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7346 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7347 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7348 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007349 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007350 processing.
7351
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007352 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007353 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007354 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007355 rules evaluation.
7356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007357http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7358http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7359http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007360
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007361 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7362 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7363 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7364 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7365 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007366 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007367
7368http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7369
7370 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7371 about <var-name>.
7372
7373 Example:
7374 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7375
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007376http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7378
7379 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7380 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7381 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7382 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7383 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7384 buffer is full.
7385
7386 Arguments :
7387
7388 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7389 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7390
7391 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007392 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007393 bytes.
7394
7395 Example:
7396 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007397
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007398http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7399 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7400
7401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 yes | no | yes | yes
7403
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007404 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007405 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7406 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7407 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007408
7409 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7410
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007411 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7412 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7413 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7414 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7415 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7416 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7417 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007418 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007419 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7420 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007421
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007422 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7423 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7424 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7425 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7426 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7427 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7428 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007429 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7430 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7431 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7432 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7433 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7434 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007435
7436 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7437 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7438 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7439 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7440 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7441 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7442 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7443 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007444 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007445 downsides of rare connection failures.
7446
7447 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7448 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7449 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7450 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7451 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7452 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007453 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007454 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7455 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7456 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7457 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7458 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7459
7460 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007461 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7462 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7463 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7464 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007465
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007466 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7467 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007468
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007469 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007470
7471 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7472 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7473 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7474
7475 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7476
7477
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007478http-send-name-header [<header>]
7479 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007480 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7481 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007482 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007483 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7484
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007485 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7486 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7487 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7488 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7489 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7490 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7491 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7492 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7493 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7494 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7495 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7496 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7497 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7498 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7499 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7500 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007501
7502 See also : "server"
7503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007504id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007505 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 no | yes | yes | yes
7508 Arguments : none
7509
7510 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7511 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7512 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007513
7514
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007515ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7516 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7517 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007518 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007519
7520 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7521 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7522 and running).
7523
7524 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7525 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7526 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007527 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007528 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7529
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007530 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7531 "unless" condition is met.
7532
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007533 Example:
7534 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7535 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7536 ignore-persist if url_static
7537
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007538 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7539
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007540load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7541 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7543 yes | no | yes | yes
7544
7545 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7546 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7547 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007548 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007549 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007550 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7551 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7552 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7553
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007554 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007555 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007556 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007557
7558 Arguments:
7559 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7560 named "server-state-file".
7561
7562 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7563 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7564 name is used as a file name.
7565
7566 none don't load any stat for this backend
7567
7568 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007569 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7570 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7571 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007572 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007573 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007574
7575 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7576 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7577
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007578 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007579
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007580 global
7581 stats socket /tmp/socket
7582 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007584 defaults
7585 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007587 backend bk
7588 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7589 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007590
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007591
7592 Then one can run :
7593
7594 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7595
7596 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7597
7598 1
7599 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7600 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7601 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7602
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007603 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007604
7605 global
7606 stats socket /tmp/socket
7607 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7608
7609 defaults
7610 load-server-state-from-file local
7611
7612 backend bk
7613 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7614 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7615
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007616
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007617 Then one can run :
7618
7619 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7620
7621 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7622
7623 1
7624 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7625 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7626 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7627
7628 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7629 "show servers state"
7630
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007632log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007633log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007634 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007635no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007636 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007639
7640 Prefix :
7641 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7642 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7643 prefix does not allow arguments.
7644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007645 Arguments :
7646 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7647 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7648 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7649 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7650 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7651 parameter.
7652
7653 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7654 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7655
7656 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7657 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7658 standard syslog port).
7659
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007660 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7661 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7662 standard syslog port).
7663
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007664 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7665 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7666 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007667 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007668
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007669 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7670 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7671 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7672 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7673 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7674 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7675 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7676 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7677 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7678 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7679 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7680 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007681 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007682 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7683 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7684 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007685 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7686 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007687
7688 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7689 and "fd@2", see above.
7690
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007691 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7692 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7693 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7694 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7695 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7696 having the logs instantly available.
7697
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007698 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7699 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7700 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7701
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007702 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7703 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007704
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007705 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7706 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7707 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7708 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7709 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7710 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7711 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7712 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7713 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7714 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007715 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007716
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007717 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7718 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7719 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7720 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7721 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7722
7723 <sample_size>
7724 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7725 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7726 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7727 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7728 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7729
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007730 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7731 one of the following :
7732
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007733 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7734 field is stripped. This is the default.
7735 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7736 rfc3164.
7737
7738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7740
7741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7743
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007744 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7745 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7746 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7747 designed to be used with a local log server.
7748
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007749 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7750 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7751 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7752 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7753 systemd logger consumes.
7754
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007755 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7756 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7757 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7758 used with a local log server.
7759
7760 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7761 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7762 designed to be used with a local log server.
7763
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007764 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7765 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7766 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7767 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7768
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007769 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7770
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007771 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7772 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7773 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7774
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007775 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7776 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7777 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7778 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007779
7780 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7781 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7782 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007783 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7784 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7785 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7786 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7787 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007788
7789 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7790
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007791 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7792 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7793 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007794
7795 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7796 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7797 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7798 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7799
7800 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7801 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007802
7803 Example :
7804 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007805 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7806 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7807 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007808 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007809 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7810 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007811 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007812
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007813
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007814log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007815 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7817 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007818
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007819 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7820 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7821 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7822 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7823 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007824
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007825 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7826 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007827
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007828log-format-sd <string>
7829 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7831 yes | yes | yes | no
7832
7833 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7834 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7835 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7836 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7837 which covers the log format string in depth.
7838
7839 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7840 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7841
7842 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7843 log format to "rfc5424".
7844
7845 Example :
7846 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7847
7848
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007849log-tag <string>
7850 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7852 yes | yes | yes | yes
7853
7854 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7855 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007856 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007857 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7858 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7859 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7860 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7861 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7862 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007863
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007864max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7865 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7867 yes | no | yes | yes
7868
7869 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7870 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7871 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7872 servers.
7873
7874 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007875 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007876 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7877 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7878 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007879 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007880 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7881 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7882 picking a different server.
7883
7884 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7885 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7886 even if they have to be queued.
7887
7888 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7889 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7890
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007891max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7892 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7893 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7894 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007895
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007896maxconn <conns>
7897 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 yes | yes | yes | no
7900 Arguments :
7901 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7902 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7903 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7904 closes.
7905
7906 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007907 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007908 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7909 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007910 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7911 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7912 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7913 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007914
7915 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7916 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7917 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7918
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007919 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7920 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007921
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007922 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7923
7924
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007925mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007926 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | yes | yes | yes
7929 Arguments :
7930 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7931 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7932 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7933 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7934
7935 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7936 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7937 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7938 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7939 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7940
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007941 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7942 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7943 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007944
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007945 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007946 defaults http_instances
7947 mode http
7948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007949
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007950monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007951 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7953 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007954 Arguments :
7955 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7956 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007957 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007958 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7959 backend and its backup.
7960
7961 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7962 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7963 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7964 servers in a list of backends.
7965
7966 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7967 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7968 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007969 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007970 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7971 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007972 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007973 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7974 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007975
7976 Example:
7977 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007979 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7980 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7981 monitor-uri /site_alive
7982 monitor fail if site_dead
7983
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007984 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985
7986
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007987monitor-uri <uri>
7988 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7990 yes | yes | yes | no
7991 Arguments :
7992 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7993 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7994
7995 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7996 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7997 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7998 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7999 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8000 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8001 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8002 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8003
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008004 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008005 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8006 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8007 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8008 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8009 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8010 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008011
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008012 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8013 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8014 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8015 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008017 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008018 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008019 frontend www
8020 mode http
8021 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8022
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008023 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008025
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008026option abortonclose
8027no option abortonclose
8028 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 yes | no | yes | yes
8031 Arguments : none
8032
8033 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8034 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8035 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8036 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008037 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008038 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8039 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8040 encountered while delivering the response.
8041
8042 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8043 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8044 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8045 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8046 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8047 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008048 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008050 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008051 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8052 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8053 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8054
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008055 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8056 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008057 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8058 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8059 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8060 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8061 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8062 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008063 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008064
8065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8067
8068 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8069
8070
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008071option accept-invalid-http-request
8072no option accept-invalid-http-request
8073 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8075 yes | yes | yes | no
8076 Arguments : none
8077
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008078 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008079 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008080 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008081 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8082 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8083 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8084 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8085 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008086 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8087 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8088 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8089 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008090 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008091 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008092 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8093 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8094 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008095
8096 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8097 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8098 been confirmed.
8099
8100 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8101 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008102 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8103 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008104 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8105
8106 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8107 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8108
8109 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8110 stats socket.
8111
8112
8113option accept-invalid-http-response
8114no option accept-invalid-http-response
8115 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8117 yes | no | yes | yes
8118 Arguments : none
8119
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008120 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008121 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008122 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008123 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8124 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8125 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8126 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8127 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008128 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8129 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8130 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008131
8132 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8133 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8134 been confirmed.
8135
8136 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8137 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8138 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8139 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8140
8141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8143
8144 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8145 stats socket.
8146
8147
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008148option allbackups
8149no option allbackups
8150 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | no | yes | yes
8153 Arguments : none
8154
8155 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8156 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8157 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8158 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8159 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8160 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8161 order between the backup servers anymore.
8162
8163 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8164 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8165
8166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8168
8169
8170option checkcache
8171no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008172 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8174 yes | no | yes | yes
8175 Arguments : none
8176
8177 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8178 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008179 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008180 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8181 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008182 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008183
8184 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008185 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008186 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008187 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8188 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008189 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008191 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8192 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008193 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008194 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8195 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008196 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008197 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8198 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8199 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8200 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8201 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8202 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8203 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8204 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8205 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8206
8207 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008208 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8209 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8210 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8211 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008212
8213 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8214 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008215 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008216 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008217
8218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8220
8221
8222option clitcpka
8223no option clitcpka
8224 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8226 yes | yes | yes | no
8227 Arguments : none
8228
8229 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8230 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008231 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008232 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8233
8234 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8235 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8236 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8237 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8238
8239 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8240 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8241 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8242 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8243 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8244
8245 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8246
8247 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8248 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8249 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8250
8251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8253
8254 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8255
8256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008257option contstats
8258 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8260 yes | yes | yes | no
8261 Arguments : none
8262
8263 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8264 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8265 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008266 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008267 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8268 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8269 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8270 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8271 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008272
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008273option disable-h2-upgrade
8274no option disable-h2-upgrade
8275 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8276 connection.
8277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | yes | yes | no
8279 Arguments : none
8280
8281 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8282 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8283 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8284 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008285 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8286 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8287 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8288 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8289 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8290 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008291
8292 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8293 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008294
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008295option dontlog-normal
8296no option dontlog-normal
8297 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8299 yes | yes | yes | no
8300 Arguments : none
8301
8302 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8303 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8304 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8305 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8306 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8307 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8308 logged.
8309
8310 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8311 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8312 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008314 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008315 logging.
8316
8317
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008318option dontlognull
8319no option dontlognull
8320 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8322 yes | yes | yes | no
8323 Arguments : none
8324
8325 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8326 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8327 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8328 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8329 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8330 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008331 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8332 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8333 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008334
8335 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008337 would not be logged.
8338
8339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8341
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008342 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008343 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008344
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008345
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008346option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008347 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 yes | yes | yes | yes
8350 Arguments :
8351 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8352 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008353 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008354 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008355
8356 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8357 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8358 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8359 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8360 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8361 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8362 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008363 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8364 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8365 possible that the client has already brought one.
8366
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008367 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008368 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008369 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008370 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008371 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008372 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008373
8374 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8375 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8376 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8377 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8378 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8379 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008380 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008381
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008382 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8383 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008384 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008385 are under the control of the end-user.
8386
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008387 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008388 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8389 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008390 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8391 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8392 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008393
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008394 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008395 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8396 frontend www
8397 mode http
8398 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8399
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008400 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8401 backend www
8402 mode http
8403 option forwardfor header X-Client
8404
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008405 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008406 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008407
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008408
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008409option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8410no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8411 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | yes | yes | no
8414 Arguments : none
8415
8416 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8417 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8418 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8419 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8420 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8421 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8422 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8423
8424 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8425 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8426 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8427 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8428 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8429 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8430 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8431 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8432 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8433 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8434
8435 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8436
8437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8439
8440 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8441 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8442
8443
8444option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8445no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8446 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8448 yes | no | yes | yes
8449 Arguments : none
8450
8451 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8452 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8453 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8454 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8455 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8456 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8457 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8458
8459 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8460 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8461 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8462 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8463 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8464 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8465 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8466 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8467 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8468 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8469
8470 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8471
8472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8474
8475 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8476 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8477
8478
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008479option http-buffer-request
8480no option http-buffer-request
8481 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 yes | yes | yes | yes
8484 Arguments : none
8485
8486 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8487 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8488 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8489 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8490 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8491 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008492 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8493 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8494 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8495 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008496
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008497 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8498 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008499
8500
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008501option http-ignore-probes
8502no option http-ignore-probes
8503 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8505 yes | yes | yes | no
8506 Arguments : none
8507
8508 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8509 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8510 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8511 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8512 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8513 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8514 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8515 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8516 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008517 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8518 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008519 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8520
8521 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8522 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8523 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8524 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8525 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8526 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8527 are often the only way to detect them.
8528
8529 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8530 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8531
8532 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8533
8534
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008535option http-keep-alive
8536no option http-keep-alive
8537 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8539 yes | yes | yes | yes
8540 Arguments : none
8541
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008542 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8543 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008544 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8545 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008546 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8547 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8548 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008549
8550 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8551 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008552 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8553 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8554 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8555 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8556 situations where this option may be useful :
8557
8558 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008559 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008560
8561 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8562 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8563
8564 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8565 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8566 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8567 request.
8568
8569 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8570 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008571 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8572 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8573 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008574
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008575 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8576 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8577 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8578 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8579 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8580 not set.
8581
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008582 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8583 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8584 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008586 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008587 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008588 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008589
8590
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008591option http-no-delay
8592no option http-no-delay
8593 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8595 yes | yes | yes | yes
8596 Arguments : none
8597
8598 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8599 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8600 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8601 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8602 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8603 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8604 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008605 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008606 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8607 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8608 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8609 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8610 affected.
8611
8612 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8613 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8614 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8615 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8616 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8617 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8618 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8619 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8620 latency environments.
8621
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008622 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8623
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008624
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008625option http-pretend-keepalive
8626no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008627 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008629 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008630 Arguments : none
8631
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008632 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008633 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8634 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8635 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008636 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008637 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8638 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8639 consider the response complete.
8640
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008641 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008642 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008643 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008644 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008645 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008646 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8647
8648 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8649 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8650 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8651 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008652 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8653 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008654 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8655
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008656 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8657 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8658 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8659 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8660 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8661 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008662
8663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8665
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008666 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008667 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008668
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008669
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008670option http-server-close
8671no option http-server-close
8672 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8674 yes | yes | yes | yes
8675 Arguments : none
8676
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008677 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8678 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8679 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8680 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008681 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8682 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8683 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8684 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8685 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8686 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8687 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8688 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8689 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8690 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8691 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008692
8693 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8694 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8695 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8696 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008697 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8698 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008699
8700 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8701 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008702 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8703 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8704 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008705
8706 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8707 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8708
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008709 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8710 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008711
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008712option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008713no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008714 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8716 yes | yes | yes | no
8717 Arguments : none
8718
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008719 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008720 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8721 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8722 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8723 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8724 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008725 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008726
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008727 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008728 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008729 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8730 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8731 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008732
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008733 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8734 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8735 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8736 front of an existing proxy.
8737
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008738 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8739
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008740 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008741
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008742option httpchk
8743option httpchk <uri>
8744option httpchk <method> <uri>
8745option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008746 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8748 yes | no | yes | yes
8749 Arguments :
8750 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8751 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8752 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8753 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8754 ones.
8755
8756 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8757 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8758 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8759
8760 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8761 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8762 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008763 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008764
8765 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8766 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8767 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8768 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8769 the lack of any response.
8770
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008771 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8772 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8773 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8774 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8775
8776 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8777 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8778 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008779
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008780 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8781 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008782 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008783 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008784 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008785
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008786 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8787 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8788 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8789 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8790
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008791 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008792 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8793 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8794 backend https_relay
8795 mode tcp
8796 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8797 http-check send hdr Host www
8798 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008799
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008800 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8801 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8802 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008803
8804
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008805option httpclose
8806no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008807 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8809 yes | yes | yes | yes
8810 Arguments : none
8811
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008812 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8813 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8814 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8815 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008816 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008817
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008818 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8819 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008820 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008821 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8822 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008823
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008824 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8825 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8826 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008827
8828 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8829 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008830 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8831 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8832 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008833
8834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8836
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008837 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008838
8839
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008840option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008841 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008843 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008844 Arguments :
8845 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8846 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8847 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008848 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008849 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008850
8851 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8852 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8853 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8854 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8855 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8856 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8857 ports.
8858
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008859 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8860 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008861
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008862 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8863
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008864 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008865
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008866option httpslog
8867 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8869 yes | yes | yes | no
8870
8871 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8872 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8873 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8874 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8875 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8876 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8877 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8878
8879 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8880
8881 See also : section 8 about logging.
8882
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008883
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008884option independent-streams
8885no option independent-streams
8886 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8888 yes | yes | yes | yes
8889 Arguments : none
8890
8891 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8892 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8893 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8894 receive data or not.
8895
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008896 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008897 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8898 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8899 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8900 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8901 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8902 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8903 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8904 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8905 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8906 socket buffers.
8907
8908 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8909 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8910 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8911 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8912 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8913
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008914 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008915
8916
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008917option ldap-check
8918 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8920 yes | no | yes | yes
8921 Arguments : none
8922
8923 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8924 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8925 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8926 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8927
8928 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8929 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8930
8931 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8932 configure it.
8933
8934 Example :
8935 option ldap-check
8936
8937 See also : "option httpchk"
8938
8939
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008940option external-check
8941 Use external processes for server health checks
8942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8943 yes | no | yes | yes
8944
8945 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8946 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8947 command".
8948
8949 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8950
8951 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8952
8953
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008954option log-health-checks
8955no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008956 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8958 yes | no | yes | yes
8959 Arguments : none
8960
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008961 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8962 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8963 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008964
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008965 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8966 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8967 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8968 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8969 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008971 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008972 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008973
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008974 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8975 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8976 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008977
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008978
8979option log-separate-errors
8980no option log-separate-errors
8981 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | yes | yes | no
8984 Arguments : none
8985
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008986 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008987 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8988 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8989 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8990 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8991 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8992 provides very important information.
8993
8994 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8995 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8996 error logs.
8997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008998 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008999 logging.
9000
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009001
9002option logasap
9003no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009004 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 yes | yes | yes | no
9007 Arguments : none
9008
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009009 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9010 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9011 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9012 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9013
9014 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9015 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9016 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9017 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9018 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009019 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009020 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9021 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9022 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9023 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009024 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009025
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009026 Examples :
9027 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9028 mode http
9029 option httplog
9030 option logasap
9031 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9032
9033 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9034 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9035 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9036 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009038 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009039 logging.
9040
9041
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +02009042option log-error-via-logformat
9043no option log-error-via-logformat
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +02009044 Enable or disable dedicated connection error logging.
9045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9046 yes | yes | yes | no
9047 Arguments : none
9048
9049 In case of connection error, if the option is disabled, a log line following
9050 the format described in section 8.2.6, the legacy format, will be emitted.
9051 Otherwise, a log line following the configured log-format for the listener
9052 will be emitted. The error code and the corresponding message found in the
9053 error log can be added to a log-format thanks to the "fc_conn_err" and
9054 "fc_conn_err_str" sample fetches.
9055
9056 See also : "option httpslog" and section 8 about logging.
9057
9058
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009059option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009060 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9062 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009063 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009064 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9065 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009066 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9067 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009068
9069 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9070 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009071 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009072 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009073 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9074 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9075 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009076
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009077 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9078 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9079 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009080
9081 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009082 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009083 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9084 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9085 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9086 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9087 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9088 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9089 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9090
9091 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9092 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009093
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009094 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009095
9096 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9097 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9098 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9099 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009100 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009101 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009102
9103 See also: "option httpchk"
9104
9105
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009106option nolinger
9107no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009108 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9110 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009111 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009112
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009113 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009114 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9115 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9116 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9117 connections.
9118
9119 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9120 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009121 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9122 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9123 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9124 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9125 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9126 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9127 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9128 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9129 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9130 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9131 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9132 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9133 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009134
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009135 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9136 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9137 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9138 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9139 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140
9141 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9142 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009143 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009144 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009145 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009146
9147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9149
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009150 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9151 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009152
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009153option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9154 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9156 yes | yes | yes | yes
9157 Arguments :
9158 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9159 matching <network>
9160 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9161 header name.
9162
9163 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9164 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9165 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9166 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9167 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9168 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9169 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9170 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9171 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9172 possible that the client has already brought one.
9173
9174 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9175 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9176 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9177 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9178 header and requires different one.
9179
9180 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9181 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9182 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009183 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9184 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9185 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9186 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9187 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009188
9189 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9190 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9191 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9192 both are defined.
9193
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009194 Examples :
9195 # Original Destination address
9196 frontend www
9197 mode http
9198 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9199
9200 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9201 backend www
9202 mode http
9203 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009205 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009206
9207
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009208option persist
9209no option persist
9210 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9212 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009213 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009214
9215 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9216 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9217 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9218 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9219 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9220 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9221 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9222 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9223 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9224 redirected to another valid server.
9225
9226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9228
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009229 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009230
9231
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009232option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9233 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9235 yes | no | yes | yes
9236 Arguments :
9237 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9238 PostgreSQL server.
9239
9240 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9241 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9242 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9243 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9244
9245 See also: "option httpchk"
9246
9247
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009248option prefer-last-server
9249no option prefer-last-server
9250 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9252 yes | no | yes | yes
9253 Arguments : none
9254
9255 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009256 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009257 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9258 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009259 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009260 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009261 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009262 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9263 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009264 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009265 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009266 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9267 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9268 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009269 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9270 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9271 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009272
9273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9275
9276 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9277
9278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009279option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009280option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009281no option redispatch
9282 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9284 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009285 Arguments :
9286 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9287 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9288 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009289 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009290 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009291 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009292 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9293 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9294 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9295
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009296
9297 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9298 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9299 be able to access the service anymore.
9300
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009301 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9302 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009303
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009304 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9305 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9306 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9307 following order:
9308
9309 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9310
9311 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9312 list, or
9313
9314 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9315
9316 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9317 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9318
9319 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9320 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9321 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9322 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9323
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009324 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009325 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9326 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9330
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009331 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009332
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009333
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009334option redis-check
9335 Use redis health checks for server testing
9336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9337 yes | no | yes | yes
9338 Arguments : none
9339
9340 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9341 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9342 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9343 find the "+PONG" response message.
9344
9345 Example :
9346 option redis-check
9347
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009348 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009349
9350
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009351option smtpchk
9352option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9353 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009356 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009357 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009358 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009359 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9360
9361 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9362 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9363 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9364
9365 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9366 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9367 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9368 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9369 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9370 dead server.
9371
9372 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9373 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009374 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009375 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9376
9377 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9378 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9379 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9380 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009381 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009382
9383 Example :
9384 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9385
9386 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009389option socket-stats
9390no option socket-stats
9391
9392 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9394 yes | yes | yes | no
9395
9396 Arguments : none
9397
9398
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009399option splice-auto
9400no option splice-auto
9401 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9403 yes | yes | yes | yes
9404 Arguments : none
9405
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009406 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009407 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009408 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009409 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009410 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009411 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9412 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9413 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9414 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9415
9416 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9417 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9418 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9419 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9420 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9421 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9422 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9423 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9424 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9425 keyword.
9426
9427 Example :
9428 option splice-auto
9429
9430 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9431 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9432
9433 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9434 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9435
9436
9437option splice-request
9438no option splice-request
9439 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9441 yes | yes | yes | yes
9442 Arguments : none
9443
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009444 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009445 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009446 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9447 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9448 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9449 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9450
9451 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9452
9453 Example :
9454 option splice-request
9455
9456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9458
9459 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9460 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9461
9462
9463option splice-response
9464no option splice-response
9465 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9467 yes | yes | yes | yes
9468 Arguments : none
9469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009470 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009471 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009472 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9473 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9474 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9475 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9476
9477 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9478
9479 Example :
9480 option splice-response
9481
9482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9484
9485 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9486 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9487
9488
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009489option spop-check
9490 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9492 no | no | no | yes
9493 Arguments : none
9494
9495 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9496 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9497 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9498 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9499
9500 Example :
9501 option spop-check
9502
9503 See also : "option httpchk"
9504
9505
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009506option srvtcpka
9507no option srvtcpka
9508 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | no | yes | yes
9511 Arguments : none
9512
9513 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9514 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009515 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009516 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9517
9518 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9519 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9520 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9521 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9522
9523 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9524 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9525 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9526 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9527 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9528
9529 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9530
9531 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9532 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9533 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9534
9535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9537
9538 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9539
9540
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009541option ssl-hello-chk
9542 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9544 yes | no | yes | yes
9545 Arguments : none
9546
9547 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9548 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9549 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9550 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9551 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9552 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9553 hello message.
9554
9555 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9556 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9557 messages, which is appreciable.
9558
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009559 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009560 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9561 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009562
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009563 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9564
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009565
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009566option tcp-check
9567 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 yes | no | yes | yes
9570
9571 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9572 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9573
9574 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9575 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9576 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9577
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009578 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009579 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9580 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9581 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9582 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9583 only.
9584
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009585 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009586 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009587 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9588 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9589 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009591 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9593 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009594 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009595 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9596 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9597 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9598 the respective protocols.
9599 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009602 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009604 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9605 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9606 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9607 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009608
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009609 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9610 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9611 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009612
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009613
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009614 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009615 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009616 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009617 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009618
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009619 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009621 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622
9623 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9624 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009626 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009627 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009629 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009630 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009631 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9632 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009633 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9635 tcp-check expect string +OK
9636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009637 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009638 (send many headers before analyzing)
9639 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009640 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009641 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9642 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9643 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9644 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009645 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009646
9647
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009648 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009649
9650
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009651option tcp-smart-accept
9652no option tcp-smart-accept
9653 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9655 yes | yes | yes | no
9656 Arguments : none
9657
9658 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9659 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9660 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9661 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9662 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9663 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9664
9665 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9666 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9667 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9668 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9669
9670 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9671 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9672 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009674
9675 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9676 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9677 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9678
9679 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9680 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9681 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9682
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009683 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9684
9685
9686option tcp-smart-connect
9687no option tcp-smart-connect
9688 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9690 yes | no | yes | yes
9691 Arguments : none
9692
9693 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9694 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9695 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9696 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9697 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9698
9699 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9700 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9701 complex.
9702
9703 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9704 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9705 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9706
9707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9709
9710 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9711
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009712
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009713option tcpka
9714 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9716 yes | yes | yes | yes
9717 Arguments : none
9718
9719 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9720 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009721 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009722 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9723
9724 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9725 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9726 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9727 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9728
9729 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9730 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9731 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9732 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9733 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9734
9735 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9736
9737 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9738 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9739 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9740 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9741 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9742 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9743 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9744 backends.
9745
9746 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9747
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009748
9749option tcplog
9750 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009752 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009753 Arguments : none
9754
9755 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9756 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9757 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9758 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9759 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9760 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9761 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9762 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9763
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009764 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009766 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009767
9768
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009769option transparent
9770no option transparent
9771 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009773 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009774 Arguments : none
9775
9776 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9777 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9778 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9779 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9780 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9781 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9782 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9783 appropriate server.
9784
9785 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9786 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9787
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009788 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009789 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009790
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009792external-check command <command>
9793 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9795 yes | no | yes | yes
9796
9797 Arguments :
9798 <command> is the external command to run
9799
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009800 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9801
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009802 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009803
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009804 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9805 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9806 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9807 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9808 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9809 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009810
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009811 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9812
9813 Environment variables :
9814 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9815 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9816
9817 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9818
9819 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9820
9821 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9822 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9823 for a UNIX socket).
9824
9825 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9826
9827 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9828
9829 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9830
9831 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9832
9833 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9834
9835 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9836 socket).
9837
9838 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9839 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9840
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009841 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9842
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009843 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9844 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9845 failed.
9846
9847 Example :
9848 external-check command /bin/true
9849
9850 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9851
9852
9853external-check path <path>
9854 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9856 yes | no | yes | yes
9857
9858 Arguments :
9859 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9860
9861 The default path is "".
9862
9863 Example :
9864 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9865
9866 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9867 "external-check command"
9868
9869
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009870persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009871persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009872 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9874 yes | no | yes | yes
9875 Arguments :
9876 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009877 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9878 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009879
9880 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9881 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009882 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009883 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9884 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9885 forwarded to this server.
9886
9887 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9888 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9889 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009890 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009891 a single "listen" section.
9892
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009893 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9894 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9895 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9896
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009897 Example :
9898 listen tse-farm
9899 bind :3389
9900 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9901 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9902 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9903 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9904 persist rdp-cookie
9905 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009906 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009907 balance rdp-cookie
9908 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9909 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9910
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009911 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9912 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009913
9914
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009915rate-limit sessions <rate>
9916 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9918 yes | yes | yes | no
9919 Arguments :
9920 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9921 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9922
9923 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9924 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9925 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009926 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009927 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9928 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9929
9930 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9931 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9932 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9933 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9934
9935 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9936 listen smtp
9937 mode tcp
9938 bind :25
9939 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009940 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009941
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009942 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9943 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9944 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009945
9946 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9947
9948
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009949redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9950redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9951redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009952 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9954 no | yes | yes | yes
9955
9956 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009957 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009958
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009959 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009960 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009961 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9962 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9963 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009964
9965 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9966 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9967 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9968 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9969 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009970 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9971 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9972 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9973 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009974
9975 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9976 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9977 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9978 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9979 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9980 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009981 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009982 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009983 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9984 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9985 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009986
9987 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009988 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9989 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9990 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009991 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009992 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9993 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9994 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9995 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009996
9997 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009998 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009999
10000 - "drop-query"
10001 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10002 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10003 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10004 with a location-type redirect.
10005
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010006 - "append-slash"
10007 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10008 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10009 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10010 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10011
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010012 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10013 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10014 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10015 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10016 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10017 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10018 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10019
10020 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10021 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10022 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10023 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10024 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10025 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10026 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010027
10028 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10029 acl clear dst_port 80
10030 acl secure dst_port 8080
10031 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010032 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010033 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010034 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10035
10036 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010037 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10038 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10039 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010040 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010041
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010042 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10043 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10044 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10045
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010046 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010047 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010048
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010049 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010050 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10051 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10052 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010053
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010054 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010055
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010056
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010057retries <value>
10058 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10059 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10060 yes | no | yes | yes
10061 Arguments :
10062 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10063 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10064 default value is 3.
10065
10066 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10067 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10068 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10069
10070 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010071 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10072 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010073
10074 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10075 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10076
10077 See also : "option redispatch"
10078
10079
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010080retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010081 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10082 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10083 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010084 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10085 yes | no | yes | yes
10086 Arguments :
10087 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10088 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10089 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10090 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10091
10092 none never retry
10093
10094 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10095 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10096
10097 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10098 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10099 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10100 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10101 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10102 processing the request.
10103
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010104 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10105 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10106 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10107 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10108 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10109 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10110 overflow attack for example).
10111
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010112 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10113 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10114 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10115 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10116 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10117 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10118 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10119 amplify denial of service attacks.
10120
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010121 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10122 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10123 considered to be safe to retry.
10124
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010125 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10126 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10127 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10128 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10129 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010130
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010131 all-retryable-errors
10132 retry request for any error that are considered
10133 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10134 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10135 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10136
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010137 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10138 not cumulative.
10139
10140 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10141 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10142 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10143 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10144
10145 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10146 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10147 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10148 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10149 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10150 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10151 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10152 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10153 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10154 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10155 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10156 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10157
10158 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10159 should not use this directive.
10160
10161 The default is "conn-failure".
10162
10163 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10164
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010165server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010166 Declare a server in a backend
10167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10168 no | no | yes | yes
10169 Arguments :
10170 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010171 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010172 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010173
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010174 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10175 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10176 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10177 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010178 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10179 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010180 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010181 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10182 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010183 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10184 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10185 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10186 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10187 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10188 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10189 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010190 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010191 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10192 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10193 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10194 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10195 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10196 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010197 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10198 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010199 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10200 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010202 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010203 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10204 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10205 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10206 adding this value to the client's port.
10207
10208 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10209 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010210 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010211
10212 Examples :
10213 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10214 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010215 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010216 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10217 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10218 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010219
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010220 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10221 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10222 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10223 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10224 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10225
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010226 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10227 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010228
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010229server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010230 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010231 this backend.
10232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10233 no | no | yes | yes
10234
10235 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10236 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10237 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10238 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10239 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010240
10241 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10242 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10243
10244 global
10245 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10246
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010247 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010248 load-server-state-from-file
10249
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010250 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010251 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010252
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010253server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10254 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10255 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10257 no | no | yes | yes
10258
10259 Arguments:
10260 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10261
10262 <num | range>
10263 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10264 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10265 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10266 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10267
10268 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10269
10270 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10271
10272 <params*>
10273 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10274 keyword.
10275
10276 Examples:
10277 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10278 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10279 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10280
10281 # or
10282 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10283
10284 # would be equivalent to:
10285 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10286 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10287 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10288
10289
10290
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010291source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010292source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010293source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010294 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10296 yes | no | yes | yes
10297 Arguments :
10298 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10299 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010300
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010301 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010302 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10303 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10304 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10305 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10306 supported prefixes are :
10307 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10308 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10309 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010310 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010311 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10312 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010313
10314 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10315 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010316 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10317 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10318 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319
10320 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10321 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10322 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10323 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10324 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10325 <addr>.
10326
10327 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10328 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10329 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10330 port.
10331
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010332 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10333 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10334 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10335 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010336 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010337 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10338 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10339 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10340 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10341 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10342 HTTP header.
10343
10344 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10345 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010346 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010347 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10348 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10349 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10350 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10351 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10352 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10353 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10354
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010355 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10356 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10357 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10358 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10359 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10360 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10361
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010362 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10363 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10364 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10365 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10366
10367 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10368 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10369 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10370 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10371 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10372 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10373
10374 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10375 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10376 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10377 there are two methods :
10378
10379 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10380 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10381 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10382 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10383 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10384 of the client ranges may be used.
10385
10386 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10387 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10388 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10389 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10390 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10391 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10392 same session.
10393
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010394 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10395 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10396 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010397 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010398
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010399 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10400
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010401 Examples :
10402 backend private
10403 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10404 source 192.168.1.200
10405
10406 backend transparent_ssl1
10407 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10408 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10409
10410 backend transparent_ssl2
10411 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10412 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10413 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10414
10415 backend transparent_ssl3
10416 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10417 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10418 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10419
10420 backend transparent_smtp
10421 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10422 # with Tproxy version 4.
10423 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10424
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010425 backend transparent_http
10426 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10427 # proxy.
10428 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010430 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010431 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10432
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010433
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010434srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10435 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10436 the connection on the server side.
10437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10438 yes | no | yes | yes
10439 Arguments :
10440 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10441
10442 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10443 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010444 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10445 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010446
10447 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10448
10449
10450srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10451 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10452 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10453 server side.
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | no | yes | yes
10456 Arguments :
10457 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10458 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10459 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10460 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10461
10462 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10463 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010464 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10465 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010466
10467 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10468
10469
10470srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10471 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10473 yes | no | yes | yes
10474 Arguments :
10475 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10476 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10477 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10478 document.
10479
10480 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10481 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010482 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10483 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010484
10485 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10486
10487
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010488stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10489 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010491 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010492
10493 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10494 matched.
10495
10496 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10497 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10498
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010499 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10500 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10501 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10502 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010503
10504 Example :
10505 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10506 backend stats_localhost
10507 stats enable
10508 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10509
10510 Example :
10511 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10512 backend stats_auth
10513 stats enable
10514 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10515 stats admin if TRUE
10516
10517 Example :
10518 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10519 userlist stats-auth
10520 group admin users admin
10521 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10522 group readonly users haproxy
10523 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10524
10525 backend stats_auth
10526 stats enable
10527 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10528 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10529 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10530 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10531
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010532 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10533 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010534
10535
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010536stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10537 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010539 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010540 Arguments :
10541 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10542
10543 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10544
10545 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10546 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10547 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10548 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10549 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10550 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10551
10552 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10553 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10554 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010555 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010556
10557 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10558 report using "stats scope".
10559
10560 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10561 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10562 unobvious parameters.
10563
10564 Example :
10565 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10566 backend public_www
10567 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10568 stats enable
10569 stats hide-version
10570 stats scope .
10571 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010573 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10574 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10575
10576 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10577 backend private_monitoring
10578 stats enable
10579 stats uri /admin?stats
10580 stats refresh 5s
10581
10582 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10583
10584
10585stats enable
10586 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010588 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010589 Arguments : none
10590
10591 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10592 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10593 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10594 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10595 - stats auth : no authentication
10596 - stats scope : no restriction
10597
10598 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10599 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10600 unobvious parameters.
10601
10602 Example :
10603 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10604 backend public_www
10605 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10606 stats enable
10607 stats hide-version
10608 stats scope .
10609 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010610 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010611 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10612 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10613
10614 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10615 backend private_monitoring
10616 stats enable
10617 stats uri /admin?stats
10618 stats refresh 5s
10619
10620 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10621
10622
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010623stats hide-version
10624 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010626 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010627 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010628
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010629 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10630 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10631 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10632 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10633 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10634 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010636 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10637 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10638 unobvious parameters.
10639
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010640 Example :
10641 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10642 backend public_www
10643 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010644 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010645 stats hide-version
10646 stats scope .
10647 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010649 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10650 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010651
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010652 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10653 backend private_monitoring
10654 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010655 stats uri /admin?stats
10656 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010657
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010658 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010659
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010660
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010661stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10662 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10663 Access control for statistics
10664
10665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10666 no | no | yes | yes
10667
10668 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10669 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10670 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10671 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10672 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10673 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10674
10675 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10676 instance.
10677
10678 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10679 about ACL usage.
10680
10681
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010682stats realm <realm>
10683 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010685 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010686 Arguments :
10687 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10688 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10689 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10690
10691 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10692 using a backslash ('\').
10693
10694 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10695 only related to authentication.
10696
10697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10699 unobvious parameters.
10700
10701 Example :
10702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10703 backend public_www
10704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10705 stats enable
10706 stats hide-version
10707 stats scope .
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10712
10713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10714 backend private_monitoring
10715 stats enable
10716 stats uri /admin?stats
10717 stats refresh 5s
10718
10719 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10720
10721
10722stats refresh <delay>
10723 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments :
10727 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10728 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10729 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10730 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10731 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10732 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10733
10734 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10735 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10736 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010737 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010738
10739 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10740 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10741 unobvious parameters.
10742
10743 Example :
10744 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10745 backend public_www
10746 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10747 stats enable
10748 stats hide-version
10749 stats scope .
10750 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010751 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010752 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10753 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10754
10755 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10756 backend private_monitoring
10757 stats enable
10758 stats uri /admin?stats
10759 stats refresh 5s
10760
10761 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10762
10763
10764stats scope { <name> | "." }
10765 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010767 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010768 Arguments :
10769 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10770 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10771 section in which the statement appears.
10772
10773 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10774 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10775 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10776 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10777 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10778 exists.
10779
10780 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10781 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10782 unobvious parameters.
10783
10784 Example :
10785 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10786 backend public_www
10787 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10788 stats enable
10789 stats hide-version
10790 stats scope .
10791 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010792 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010793 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10794 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10795
10796 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10797 backend private_monitoring
10798 stats enable
10799 stats uri /admin?stats
10800 stats refresh 5s
10801
10802 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010804
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010805stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010808 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010809
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010810 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010811 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10812
10813 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10814 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10815
10816 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10817 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010818 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010819
10820 Example :
10821 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10822 backend private_monitoring
10823 stats enable
10824 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10825 stats uri /admin?stats
10826 stats refresh 5s
10827
10828 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10829 global section.
10830
10831
10832stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010833 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10835 yes | yes | yes | yes
10836 Arguments : none
10837
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010838 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010839 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10840 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10841 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10842 - IP (socket, server)
10843 - cookie (backend, server)
10844
10845 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10846 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010847 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010848
10849 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10850
10851
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010852stats show-modules
10853 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10855 yes | yes | yes | yes
10856 Arguments : none
10857
10858 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10859 values as a tooltip.
10860
10861 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10862 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10863 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10864
10865 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10866
10867
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010868stats show-node [ <name> ]
10869 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010871 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010872 Arguments:
10873 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10874 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10875
10876 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10877 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010878 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010879
10880 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10881 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10882 unobvious parameters.
10883
10884 Example:
10885 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10886 backend private_monitoring
10887 stats enable
10888 stats show-node Europe-1
10889 stats uri /admin?stats
10890 stats refresh 5s
10891
10892 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10893 section.
10894
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010895
10896stats uri <prefix>
10897 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010899 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010900 Arguments :
10901 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10902 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10903 query string.
10904
10905 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10906 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10907 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10908 possible to reach it in the application.
10909
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010910 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010911 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010912 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10913 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10914 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10915 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10916
10917 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10918 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10919 an address or a port to statistics only.
10920
10921 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10922 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10923 unobvious parameters.
10924
10925 Example :
10926 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10927 backend public_www
10928 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10929 stats enable
10930 stats hide-version
10931 stats scope .
10932 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010933 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010934 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10935 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10936
10937 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10938 backend private_monitoring
10939 stats enable
10940 stats uri /admin?stats
10941 stats refresh 5s
10942
10943 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10944
10945
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010946stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10947 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010949 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010950
10951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010952 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010953 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010955 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10956
10957 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10958 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10959 the "stick-table" statement.
10960
10961 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10962 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10963 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10964 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10965 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10966
10967 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10968 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10969 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10970 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10971 transformation rules.
10972
10973 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10974 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10975 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10976 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10977 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10978 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10979 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10980
10981 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10982 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10983 ACL based conditions.
10984
10985 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10986 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10987 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10988 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10989
10990 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10991 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10992 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10993 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10994
10995 Example :
10996 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10997 # last 30 minutes
10998 backend pop
10999 mode tcp
11000 balance roundrobin
11001 stick store-request src
11002 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11003 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11004 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11005
11006 backend smtp
11007 mode tcp
11008 balance roundrobin
11009 stick match src table pop
11010 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11011 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11012
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011013 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11014 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011015
11016
11017stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11018 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11020 no | no | yes | yes
11021
11022 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11023 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11024 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11025 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11026
11027 Examples :
11028 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011029 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011030
11031 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11032 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11033 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11034
11035
11036 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11037 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11038 backend http
11039 mode http
11040 balance roundrobin
11041 stick on src table https
11042 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11043 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11044 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11045
11046 backend https
11047 mode tcp
11048 balance roundrobin
11049 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11050 stick on src
11051 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11052 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11053
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011054 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011055
11056
11057stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11058 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11060 no | no | yes | yes
11061
11062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011063 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011064 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011065 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011066 server is selected.
11067
11068 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11069 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11070 the "stick-table" statement.
11071
11072 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11073 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11074 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11075 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11076 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11077 address.
11078
11079 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11080 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11081 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11082 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11083 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11084 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11085 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11086 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11087 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11088 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11089
11090 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11091 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11092 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11093 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11094 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11095 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11096 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11097
11098 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11099 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11100 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11101 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11102
11103 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11104 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11105 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11106 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11107 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11108 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011109 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11110 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11111 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11112 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11113 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11114 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011115
11116 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11117 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11118 the request.
11119
11120 Example :
11121 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11122 # last 30 minutes
11123 backend pop
11124 mode tcp
11125 balance roundrobin
11126 stick store-request src
11127 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11128 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11129 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11130
11131 backend smtp
11132 mode tcp
11133 balance roundrobin
11134 stick match src table pop
11135 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11136 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11137
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011138 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011139
11140
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011141stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011142 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011143 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011144 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011146 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147
11148 Arguments :
11149 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11150 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11151 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11152 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11153
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011154 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11155 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11156 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11157 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11158
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011159 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11160 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11161 instance.
11162
11163 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11164 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11165 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11166 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11167 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11168 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011169 to 32 characters.
11170
11171 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11172 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11173 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011174 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011175 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11176 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011177
11178 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011179 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11180 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011181 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11182 increase.
11183
11184 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011185 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11186 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11187 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011188
11189 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011190 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011191 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11192 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011193 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011194 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11195 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11196 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11197 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11198 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11199 parameter (see below).
11200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011201 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11202 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11203 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11204 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11205 soft restart.
11206
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11208 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11209 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11210 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011211 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011212 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011213 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11214 if not expiration delay is specified.
11215
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011216 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11217 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11218 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11219 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11220 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11221 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11222 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11223 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11224 token.
11225
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011226 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11227 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11228 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11229 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011230 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11231 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11232 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11233 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11234 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11235 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11236 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11237 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11238 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11239 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11240 types and their arguments.
11241
11242 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11243 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11244 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11245 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11246
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011247 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11248 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11249 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11250 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11251 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11252 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11253 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11254 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11255 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11256 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011257 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11258 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11259 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11260 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011261
11262 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11263 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11264 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11265 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11266 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11267 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11268 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11269 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11270 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11271 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11272 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11273 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011274 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11275 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11276 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11277 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011278
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011279 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11280 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11281 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011282 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011283
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011284 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11285 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11286 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011287 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011288 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011289 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011290
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011291 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11292 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11293 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11294 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11295
11296 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11297 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11298 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11299 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11300 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11301 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11302
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011303 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11304 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11305 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11306 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11307 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11308 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11309 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11310 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11311 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11312 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011313 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11314 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11315 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011316
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011317 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11318 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11319 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11320 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11321
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011322 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11323 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11324 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11325 they were received.
11326
11327 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11328 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11329 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11330 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11331 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11332
11333 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11334 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11335 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11336 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11337 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11338
11339 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11340 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11341 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11342
11343 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11344 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11345 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11346 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11347 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11348
11349 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11350 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11351 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11352 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11353 the client side.
11354
11355 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11356 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11357 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11358 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11359 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11360 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11361 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11362
11363 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11364 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11365 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11366 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11367 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11368 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011370
11371 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11372 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11373 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11374 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11375 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11376 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11377
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011378 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11379 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11380 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11381 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11382 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11383
11384 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11385 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11386 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11387 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11388 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11389 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11390
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011391 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011392 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011393 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11394 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11395
11396 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11397 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11398 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11399 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11400 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11401 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11402 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11403 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11404 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11405 recommended for better fairness.
11406
11407 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011408 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011409 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11410 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11411
11412 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11413 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11414 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11415 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11416 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11417 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11418 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11419 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11420 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11421 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011422
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011423 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11424 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011425 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11426 reference it.
11427
11428 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11429 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011430 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11431 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11432 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011433
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011434 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11435 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11436 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11437 something that can be ignored.
11438
11439 Example:
11440 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11441 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11442 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11443 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11444
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011445 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011446 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011447
11448
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011449stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011450 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11452 no | no | yes | yes
11453
11454 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011455 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011456 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011457 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011458 server is selected.
11459
11460 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11461 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11462 the "stick-table" statement.
11463
11464 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11465 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11466 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11467 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11468
11469 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11470 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11471 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11472 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11473 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11474 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011475 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011476 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11477 rules.
11478
11479 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11480 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11481 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11482 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11483 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11484 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11485 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11486
11487 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11488 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11489 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11490 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11491
11492 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11493 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11494 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11495 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11496 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11497 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011498 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11499 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11500 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11501 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11502 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11503 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11504 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11505 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11506 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011507
11508 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11509
11510 Example :
11511 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11512 backend https
11513 mode tcp
11514 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011515 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011516 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011517
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011518 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11519 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11520
11521 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11522 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11523 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11524
11525 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11526 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011527
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011528 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11529 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11530 # at offset 44.
11531
11532 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11533 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11534
11535 # Learn on response if server hello.
11536 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011537
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011538 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11539 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11540
11541 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11542 extraction.
11543
11544
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011545tcp-check comment <string>
11546 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11547 it fails.
11548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11549 yes | no | yes | yes
11550
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011551 Arguments :
11552 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11553 rule fails.
11554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011555 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11556 user-friendly error reporting.
11557
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011558 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11559 "tcp-check expect".
11560
11561
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011562tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11563 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011564 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011565 Opens a new connection
11566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011567 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011568
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011569 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011570 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11571
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011572 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011573 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011574
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011575 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011576 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11577 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011578 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011579
11580 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011581
11582 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11583
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011584 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11585
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011586 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11587
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011588 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11589
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011590 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11591 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11592 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11593 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11594
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011595 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11596 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11597 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11598 haproxy -vv.
11599
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011600 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011601
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011602 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11603 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11604 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11605
11606 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11607 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11608 of the sequence.
11609
11610 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11611 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11612 do.
11613
11614 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11615 unset-var or comment rules.
11616
11617 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011618 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11619 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11620 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11621 option tcp-check
11622 tcp-check connect
11623 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11624 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11625 tcp-check send \r\n
11626 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11627 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11628 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11629 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11630 tcp-check send \r\n
11631 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11632 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11633
11634 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11635 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011636 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011637 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11638 tcp-check connect port 143
11639 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11640 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11641
11642 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11643
11644
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011645tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011646 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011647 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011648 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011651 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011652
11653 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011654 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11655
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011656 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11657 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11658 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11659 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11660 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11661 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11662 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11663 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11664 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11665 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11666
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011667 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011668 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11669 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011670 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11671 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11672 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11673
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011674 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11675 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11676 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011677 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11678 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011679 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11680 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011681 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11682 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011683 By default "L7OK" is used.
11684
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011685 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11686 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011687 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11688 supported :
11689 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11690 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011691 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11692 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11693 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11694 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11695 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011696
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011697 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011698 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011699 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11700 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11701 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11702 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011703 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11704
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011705 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11706 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11707 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11708 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11709
11710 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11711 informational message reported in logs if an error
11712 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11713 log-format string.
11714
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011715 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11716 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11717 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11718 followed by some converters.
11719
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011720 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11721 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11722 with the usual backslash ('\').
11723 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011724 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011725 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11726 used upper or lower case.
11727
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011728 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11729
11730 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11731 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11732 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11733 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11734 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11735 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11736 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11737 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11738
11739 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11740 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11741 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11742 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11743 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11744 expression.
11745
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011746 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11747 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11748 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11749 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11750 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11751 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11752
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011753 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11754 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11755 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11756 this exact hexadecimal string.
11757 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11758
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011759 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11760 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11761 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11762 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11763 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11764 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11765 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11766 size.
11767
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011768 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11769 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11770 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11771 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11772 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11773 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11774 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11775 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11776 in a binary string before matching the response's
11777 buffer.
11778
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011779 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011780 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011781 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11782 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11783 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11784 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11785 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11786 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11787 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11788 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11789 the null character.
11790
11791 Examples :
11792 # perform a POP check
11793 option tcp-check
11794 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11795
11796 # perform an IMAP check
11797 option tcp-check
11798 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11799
11800 # look for the redis master server
11801 option tcp-check
11802 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011803 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011804 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11805 tcp-check expect string role:master
11806 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11807 tcp-check expect string +OK
11808
11809
11810 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011811 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812
11813
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011814tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11815tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11816 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11817 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011819 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011820
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011821 Arguments :
11822 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11823
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011824 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11825 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011826
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011827 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11828 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011829
11830 Examples :
11831 # look for the redis master server
11832 option tcp-check
11833 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11834 tcp-check expect string role:master
11835
11836 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011837 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011838
11839
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011840tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11841tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11842 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11843 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011845 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011847 Arguments :
11848 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011849
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011850 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11851 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011852
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011853 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11854 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11855 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011856
11857 Examples :
11858 # redis check in binary
11859 option tcp-check
11860 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11861 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11862
11863
11864 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011865 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011866
11867
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011868tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011869 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011870 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011871 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011872
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011873 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011874 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11875 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11876 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11877 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11878 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11879 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11880 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11881 and '-'.
11882
11883 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011885 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011886 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11887
11888
11889tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011890 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011892 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011893
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011894 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011895 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11896 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11897 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11898 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11899 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11900 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11901 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11902 and '-'.
11903
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011904 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011905 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11906
11907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011908tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11909 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11911 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011913 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11914 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011916 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011917
11918 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11919 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011920 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11921 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11922 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11923 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11924 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11925 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011927 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11928 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11929 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11930 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011931
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011932 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011933 - accept :
11934 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11936 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011938 - reject :
11939 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11940 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11941 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11942 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11943 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11944 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11945 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11946 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11947 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11948 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11949 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011950 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011951
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011952 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11953 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11954 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11955 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11956 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11957 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11958 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11959 hosts.
11960
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011961 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11962 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11963 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11964 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11965 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11966 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11967 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11968 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11969
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011970 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11971 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11972 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11973 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11974 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11975 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11976 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11977 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11978 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011979 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11980 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011981
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011982 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011983 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011984 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11985 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11986 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011987 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011988 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011989 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11990 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11991 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11992 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11993 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11994 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11995 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011996
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011997 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011998 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012000 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012001 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12002 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12003 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012004
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012005 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12006 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12007 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12008 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012009
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012010 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12011 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12012 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12013 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12014 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012015 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12016 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12017 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12018 layer7 information is extracted.
12019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012020 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12021 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12022 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12023 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12024 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012025
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012026 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12027 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12028 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12029 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12030 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12031 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12032 no GPC stored at this index.
12033 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12034 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12035 data_types).
12036
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012037 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12038 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12039 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12040 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12041
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012042 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12043 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12044 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12045 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12046
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012047 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12048 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12049 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12050 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12051 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12052 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12053 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12054 no GPT stored at this index.
12055 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12056 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12057
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012058 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12059 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12060 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12061 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12062 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012063
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012064 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012065 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12066 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12067 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12068 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12069 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12070 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12071 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12072 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012073 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012074
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012075 - set-src <expr> :
12076 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12077 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12078 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012079 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012081 Arguments:
12082 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12083 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012084
12085 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012086 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12087
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012088 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12089 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012090
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012091 - set-src-port <expr> :
12092 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12093 expression.
12094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012095 Arguments:
12096 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12097 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012098
12099 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012100 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12101
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012102 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12103 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12104 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012105
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012106 - set-dst <expr> :
12107 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12108 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12109 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12110 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12111 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12112
12113 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12114 followed by some converters.
12115
12116 Example:
12117
12118 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12119 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12120
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012121 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12122 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12123
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012124 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12125 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12126 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12127 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12128
12129
12130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12131 followed by some converters.
12132
12133 Example:
12134
12135 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12136
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012137 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12138 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12139 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12140
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012141 - set-tos <tos>:
12142 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12143 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12144 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12145 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12146 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12147 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12148 routers based on some information from the request.
12149
12150 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12151
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012152 - "silent-drop" :
12153 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012154 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012155 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12156 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12157 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12158 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12159 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012160 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12161 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012162 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12163 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012164 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012165 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12166 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12167 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12168 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012170 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12171 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12172 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012174 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12175 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12176 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012177
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012178 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012179 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012180 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012181
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012182 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12183 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12184 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012186 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012187 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12188 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012189
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012190 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12191
12192 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12193
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012194 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12195
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012196 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012197
12198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012199tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12200 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012202 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012204 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12205 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012207 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012208
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012209 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012210 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12211 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012212 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12213 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012215 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12216 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12217 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12218 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012219 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012220 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012221 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12222 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12223 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12224 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012225 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012226 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012228 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12229 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12230 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12231 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012232
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012233 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012234 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012235 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012236 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12237 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012238 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012239 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012240 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012241 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012242 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012243 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012244 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012245 - set-dst <expr>
12246 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012247 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012248 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012249 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012250 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012251 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012252 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012253 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012254 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012255 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012256 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012258 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12259 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012260 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12261 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012262
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012263 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12264 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12265 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12266 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12267 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12268 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012270 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012271 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12272 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012273
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012274 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12275 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12276 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12277 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12278 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12279 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012281 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012282 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12283 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12284 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12285 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12286 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12287 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12288 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12289 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12290 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12291 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012292
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012293 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012294 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12295 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12296 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012297
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012298 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12299 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12300
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012301 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12302 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12303
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012304 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12305 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12306
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012307 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12308 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12309
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012310 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12311 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12312
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012313 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012314 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12315 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012316
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012317 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12318 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012319 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012320 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12321 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012322 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012323 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012324 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012325 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12326 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012327 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012328 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12329 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012330
12331 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12332 followed by some converters.
12333
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012334 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012335 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12336 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12337 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12338 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12339 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12340 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012341 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012342 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12343 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12344
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012345 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12346
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012347 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12348 <var-name>.
12349
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012350 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12351 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12352 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12353 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12354 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12355
12356 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12357 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12358 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12359 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12360 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12361 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12362 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12363 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12364 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12365 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12366 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12367
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012368 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12369 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12370 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12371 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12372 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12373
12374 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12375
12376 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12377
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012378 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12379 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12380 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12381 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12382 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12383 evaluated.
12384
12385 Example:
12386 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12387
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012388 Example:
12389
12390 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012391 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012392
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012393 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012394 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012395 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012396 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12397 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012398 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012399 tcp-request content reject
12400
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012401 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12402 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12403 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12404 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12405 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12406 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12407 ...
12408 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12409
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012410 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012411 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12412 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12413 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012414 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012415
12416 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12417 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12418 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012419 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012420 tcp-request content reject
12421
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012422 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012423 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012424 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012425 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012426 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12427 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012428
12429 Example:
12430 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12431 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012432 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012433
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012434 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012435 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012436
12437 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012438 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012439 # protecting all our sites
12440 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012441 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12442 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012443 ...
12444 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12445
12446 backend http_dynamic
12447 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012448 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012449 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012450 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012451 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012452 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012453 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012455 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012456
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012457 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12458 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012459
12460
12461tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12462 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012464 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012465 Arguments :
12466 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12467 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12468 as explained at the top of this document.
12469
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012470 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012471 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12472 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12473 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12474 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12475
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012476 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12477 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12478 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12479 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12480
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012481 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012482 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012483 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012484 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012485 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012486 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12487 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12488 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012489
12490 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12491 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12492 it pass through unaffected.
12493
12494 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12495 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12496 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012497 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012498 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12499 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012500 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12501 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12502 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012503
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012504 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012505 "timeout client".
12506
12507
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012508tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12509 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12511 no | no | yes | yes
12512 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012513 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12514 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012515
12516 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12517
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012518 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012519 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12520 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012521 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12522 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012523
12524 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12525
12526 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12527 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12528 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12529 inserted.
12530
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012531 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012532 - accept :
12533 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12534 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12535 the rules evaluation.
12536
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012537 - close :
12538 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12539 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12540 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12541 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12542 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12543 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012544 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012545 protocols.
12546
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012547 - reject :
12548 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12549 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012550 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012551
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012552 - set-log-level <level>
12553 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12554 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12555 set-log-level".
12556
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012557 - set-mark <mark>
12558 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12559 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12560 set-mark".
12561
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012562 - set-nice <nice>
12563 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12564 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12565 set-nice".
12566
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012567 - set-tos <tos>
12568 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12569 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12570 set-tos".
12571
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012572 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12573 Sets a variable.
12574
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012575 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12576 Unsets a variable.
12577
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012578 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12579 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12580 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12581 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12582 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12583 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12584 no GPC stored at this index.
12585 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12586 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12587 data_types).
12588
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012589 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12590 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12591 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12592 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12593
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012594 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12595 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12596 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12597 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12598
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012599 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12600 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12601 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12602 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12603 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12604 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12605 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12606 no GPT stored at this index.
12607 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12608 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12609
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012610 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12611 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12612 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12613 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12614 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012615
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012616 - "silent-drop" :
12617 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012618 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012619 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12620 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12621 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12622 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12623 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012624 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12625 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012626 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12627 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012628 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012629 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12630 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12631 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12632 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12633
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012634 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12635 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12636
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012637 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12638 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12639 for changing the default action to a reject.
12640
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012641 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12642 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12643 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12644 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012645 period.
12646
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012647 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12648 declared inline.
12649
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012650 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12651 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012652 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012653 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12654 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012655 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012657 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012658 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12659 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012661 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12662 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012663
12664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12665 followed by some converters.
12666
12667 Example:
12668
12669 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12670
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012671 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12672 <var-name>.
12673
12674 Example:
12675
12676 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12677
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012678 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12679 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12680 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12681 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12682 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12683
12684 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12685
12686 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12687
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012688 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12689
12690 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12691
12692
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012693tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12694 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12696 no | yes | yes | no
12697 Arguments :
12698 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12699 below.
12700
12701 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12702
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012703 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012704 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12705 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12706 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12707 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12708 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12709 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12710 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012711 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012712 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12713 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12714 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12715 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12716 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12717 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12718 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12719 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12720 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12721 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12722 instead.
12723
12724 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12725 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12726 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12727 rules which may be inserted.
12728
12729 Several types of actions are supported :
12730 - accept : the request is accepted
12731 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12732 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012733 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012734 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012735 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012736 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012737 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012738 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012739 - set-dst <expr>
12740 - set-dst-port <expr>
12741 - set-src <expr>
12742 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012743 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012744 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012745 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012746 - silent-drop
12747
12748 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12749 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12750 sections for a complete description.
12751
12752 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12753 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12754 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12755
12756 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12757 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12758 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12759 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12760 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12761
12762 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12763 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12764
12765 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12766 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12767 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12768
12769 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12770 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12771 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12772
12773 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12774 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12775 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12776
12777 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12778 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12779 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12780
12781 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12782
12783 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12784
12785
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012786tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12787 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12789 no | no | yes | yes
12790 Arguments :
12791 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12792 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12793 as explained at the top of this document.
12794
12795 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12796
12797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012798timeout check <timeout>
12799 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12800 established.
12801
12802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12803 yes | no | yes | yes
12804 Arguments:
12805 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12806 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12807 as explained at the top of this document.
12808
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012809 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012811 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012812 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012813 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12814 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12815 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012816
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012817 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012818 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12819
12820 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12821 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012822 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012823
12824 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12825 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12826 forget about it.
12827
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012828 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12829 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012830
12831
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012832timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012833 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12835 yes | yes | yes | no
12836 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012837 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012838 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12839 as explained at the top of this document.
12840
12841 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12842 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12843 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012844 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12845 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12846 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12847 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012848 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12849 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12850 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012851 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012853 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12854 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012855 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12856 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012857
12858 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12859 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12860 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12861 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012862 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012863 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12864
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012865 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012866
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012867 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012869
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012870timeout client-fin <timeout>
12871 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12873 yes | yes | yes | no
12874 Arguments :
12875 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12876 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12877 as explained at the top of this document.
12878
12879 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12880 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12881 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12882 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12883 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12884 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12885 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012886 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12887 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12888 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012889
12890 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12891 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12892 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12893
12894 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12895
12896
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012897timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012898 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12900 yes | no | yes | yes
12901 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12904 as explained at the top of this document.
12905
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012906 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012907 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012908 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012909 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012910 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12911 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012912
12913 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12914 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12915 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12916 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012917 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012918 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12919
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012920 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012922
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012923timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12924 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12926 yes | yes | yes | yes
12927 Arguments :
12928 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12929 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12930 as explained at the top of this document.
12931
12932 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12933 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12934 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12935 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12936 once the request has started to present itself.
12937
12938 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12939 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12940 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12941 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12942 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12943
12944 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12945 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12946 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12947 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12948
12949 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12950 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012951 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012952 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12953 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012954 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012955
12956 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12957 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12958 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12959 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12960
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012961 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12962 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012963 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12964
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012965 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12966
12967
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012968timeout http-request <timeout>
12969 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012971 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012972 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012973 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012974 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12975 as explained at the top of this document.
12976
12977 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12978 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12979 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12980 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12981 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12982 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12983 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012984 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12985 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12986 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12987 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012988 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012989 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12990 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012991
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012992 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12993 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12994 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12995 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12996 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012997 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012998
12999 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13000 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013001 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013002 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13003 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13004
13005 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013006 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13007 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13008 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013009
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013010 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013011 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013012
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013013
13014timeout queue <timeout>
13015 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13017 yes | no | yes | yes
13018 Arguments :
13019 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13020 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13021 as explained at the top of this document.
13022
13023 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13024 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13025 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13026 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13027 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13028
13029 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13030 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13031 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13032 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13033
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013034 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013035
13036
13037timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013038 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13040 yes | no | yes | yes
13041 Arguments :
13042 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13043 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13044 as explained at the top of this document.
13045
13046 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13047 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13048 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13049 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13050 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13051 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13052 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13053
13054 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13055 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13056 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13057 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13058 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013059 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013060 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013061 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13062 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013063 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13064 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013065
13066 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13067 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13068 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13069 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013070 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013071 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13072
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013073 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013074
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013075
13076timeout server-fin <timeout>
13077 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13079 yes | no | yes | yes
13080 Arguments :
13081 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13082 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13083 as explained at the top of this document.
13084
13085 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13086 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13087 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13088 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13089 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13090 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13091 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13092 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13093 situations, it should not be needed.
13094
13095 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13096 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13097 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13098
13099 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13100
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101
13102timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013103 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13105 yes | yes | yes | yes
13106 Arguments :
13107 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13108 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13109 as explained at the top of this document.
13110
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013111 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13112 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13113 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013114
13115 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13116 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13117 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13118 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013119 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013120
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013121 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013122
13123
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013124timeout tunnel <timeout>
13125 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13127 yes | no | yes | yes
13128 Arguments :
13129 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13131 as explained at the top of this document.
13132
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013133 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013134 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13135 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13136 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013137 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13138 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013139 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13140 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13141 specified.
13142
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013143 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13144 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13145 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13146 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13147 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13148 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13149 state.
13150
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013151 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13152 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13153 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13154 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013155 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013156
13157 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13158 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13159 forget about it.
13160
13161 Example :
13162 defaults http
13163 option http-server-close
13164 timeout connect 5s
13165 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013166 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013167 timeout server 30s
13168 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13169
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013170 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013171
13172
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013173transparent (deprecated)
13174 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013176 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013177 Arguments : none
13178
13179 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13180 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13181 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13182 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13183 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13184 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13185 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13186 appropriate server.
13187
13188 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13189
13190 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13191 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13192
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013193 See also: "option transparent"
13194
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013195unique-id-format <string>
13196 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13198 yes | yes | yes | no
13199 Arguments :
13200 <string> is a log-format string.
13201
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013202 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13203 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13204 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13205 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013207 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013208 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013209 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13210 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13211 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13212 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13213 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13214 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013216 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13217 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013218
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013219 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013220
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013221 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013222
13223 will generate:
13224
13225 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13226
13227 See also: "unique-id-header"
13228
13229unique-id-header <name>
13230 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13232 yes | yes | yes | no
13233 Arguments :
13234 <name> is the name of the header.
13235
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013236 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13237 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013238
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013239 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013240
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013241 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013242 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13243
13244 will generate:
13245
13246 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13247
13248 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013249
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013250use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013251 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13253 no | yes | yes | no
13254 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013255 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13256 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013257
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013258 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13259 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013260
13261 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13262 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13263 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013264 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013266 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13267 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013268
13269 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13270 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13271 assign the backend.
13272
13273 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13274 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13275 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13276 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13277 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13278 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13279
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013280 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013281 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013282 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13283 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13284 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13285
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013286 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13287 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13288 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13289 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13290 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13291 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13292 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13293 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13294 cannot be forced from the request.
13295
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013296 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013297 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13298 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13299
13300 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13301 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013302
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013303use-fcgi-app <name>
13304 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13306 no | no | yes | yes
13307 Arguments :
13308 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13309
13310 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013311
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013312use-server <server> if <condition>
13313use-server <server> unless <condition>
13314 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13316 no | no | yes | yes
13317 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013318 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13319 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013320
13321 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13322
13323 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13324 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13325 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13326
13327 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13328 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13329 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13330 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13331 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13332 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13333 matches will assign the server.
13334
13335 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13336 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13337 with the next rules until one matches.
13338
13339 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13340 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13341 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13342 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13343
13344 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13345 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13346 stripped.
13347
13348 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13349 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013350 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013351 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013352 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013353
13354 Example :
13355 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013356 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013357 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013358 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013359 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013360 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013361 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013362 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13363 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13364
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013365 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13366 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13367 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13368 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013369 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013370 and we fall back to load balancing.
13371
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013372 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133755. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013376--------------------------
13377
13378The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13379depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13380settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13381written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13382described in this section.
13383
13384
133855.1. Bind options
13386-----------------
13387
13388The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13389as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13390no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13391parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13392while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13393provided immediately after the setting name.
13394
13395The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13396
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013397accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13398 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13399 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13400 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13401 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13402 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13403 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13404 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13405 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13406 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013407 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13408 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13409 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013410
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013411accept-proxy
13412 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013413 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13414 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013415 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13416 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13417 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13418 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013419 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13421 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013422 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13423 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013424
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013425allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013426 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013427 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013428 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013429 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13430 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013431
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013432alpn <protocols>
13433 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13434 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13435 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013436 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013437 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013438 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13439 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13440 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13441 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13442 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13443 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13444 preference, like below :
13445
13446 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013447
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013448backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013449 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013450 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13451
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013452curves <curves>
13453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13454 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13455 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13456 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13457 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13458 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13459
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013460ecdhe <named curve>
13461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013462 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13463 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013464
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013465ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13467 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13468 client's certificate.
13469
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013470ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13472 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13473 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13474 error is ignored.
13475
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013476ca-sign-file <cafile>
13477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13478 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13479 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13480 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13481 'generate-certificates' for details.
13482
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013483ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13485 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13486 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13487 'generate-certificates' for details.
13488
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013489ca-verify-file <cafile>
13490 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13491 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13492 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13493 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13494 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013496ciphers <ciphers>
13497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13498 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013499 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013500 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013501 information and recommendations see e.g.
13502 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13503 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13504 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13505
13506ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13507 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13508 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13509 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13510 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013511 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13512 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013513
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013514crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13516 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013517 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13518 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013519
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013520crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13522 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13523 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13524 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13525 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013526 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13527 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013528
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013529 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13530 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13531
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013532 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13533 are loaded.
13534
13535 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013536 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13537 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13538 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13539 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13540 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13541 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13542 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013543 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013544
13545 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13546 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13547 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13548 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013549 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13550 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013551
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013552 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013553
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013554 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013555 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13557 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013558 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13559 clients).
13560
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013561 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013562 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13563 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13564 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13565 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13566 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13567 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13568 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13569 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13570 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13571 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13572 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13573 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13574
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013575 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013576 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13577 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13578 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13579 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13580
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013581 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13582 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13583 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13584 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013585
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013586 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13587 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13588 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013589
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013590crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013592 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013593 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013594 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013595
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013596crt-list <file>
13597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013598 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13599 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013600
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013601 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13602
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013603 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13604 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13605 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13606 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13607 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013608
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013609 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013610 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13611 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13612 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13613 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13614 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013615 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13616 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13617 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013618
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013619 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13620 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13621 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013622
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013623 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13624
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013625 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013626 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013627 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13628 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13629 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13630 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13631 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13632 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013633
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013634 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013635 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013636 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013637 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013638 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013639 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013640
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013641defer-accept
13642 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13643 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13644 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013646 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13647 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13648 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13649 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13650 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13651 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13652 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13653
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013654expose-fd listeners
13655 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13656 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013657 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13658 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013660
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013661force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013662 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013663 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013664 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013665 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013666
13667force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013668 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013669 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013670 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013671
13672force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013674 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013675 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013676
13677force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013679 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013681
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013682force-tlsv13
13683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13684 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013686
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013687generate-certificates
13688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13689 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13690 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13691 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13692 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13693 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13694 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13695 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13696 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13697 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13698 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13699
13700 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13701 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013702 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013703 certificate is used many times.
13704
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013705gid <gid>
13706 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13707 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13708 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13709 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13710 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13711
13712group <group>
13713 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13714 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13715 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13716 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13717 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13718
13719id <id>
13720 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13721 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13722 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13723 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13724
13725interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013726 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13727 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13728 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13729 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13730 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13731 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013732 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13733 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13734 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13735 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13736 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13737 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013738
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013739level <level>
13740 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13741 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13742 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013743 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013744 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13745 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13746 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013748 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013749 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013750 all counters).
13751
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013752severity-output <format>
13753 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13754 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13755 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13756 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13757 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13758 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13759 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13760 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13761 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13762 rfc5424 convention.
13763
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013764maxconn <maxconn>
13765 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13766 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13767 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13768 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13769 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13770 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13771 eat all memory.
13772
13773mode <mode>
13774 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13775 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13776 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13777 UNIX sockets.
13778
13779mss <maxseg>
13780 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13781 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13782 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13783 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13784 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13785 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13786 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13787 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13788 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13789 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13790 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13791
13792name <name>
13793 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13794 page.
13795
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013796namespace <name>
13797 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13798 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13799 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13800 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13801
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013802nice <nice>
13803 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13804 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13805 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13806 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13807 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13808 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13809 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13810 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13811 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13812 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13813 one for an RDP socket.
13814
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013815no-ca-names
13816 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13817 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013818 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013820no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013822 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013823 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013824 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013825 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13826 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013827
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013828no-tls-tickets
13829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13830 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13831 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013832 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13833 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013834 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13835 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13836 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013837
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013838no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013840 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013841 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013842 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013843 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13844 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013845
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013846no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013848 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013849 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013850 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013851 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13852 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013853
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013854no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013856 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013857 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013858 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013859 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13860 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013861
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013862no-tlsv13
13863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13864 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13865 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13866 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013867 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13868 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013869
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013870npn <protocols>
13871 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13872 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13873 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013874 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013875 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013876 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13877 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13878 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13879 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13880 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013881
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013882prefer-client-ciphers
13883 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13884 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13885 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013886 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13887 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13888 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013889
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013890process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013891 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13892 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13893 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13894 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13895 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13896 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013897
13898 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13899
13900 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013901 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13902 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13903 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13904 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13905 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013906
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013907proto <name>
13908 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13909 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13910 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013911 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13912 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13913
13914 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13915 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13916 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13917 also reported (flag=HTX).
13918
13919 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13920 a bind line :
13921
13922 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13923 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13924 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13925
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013926 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013927 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013928 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013929 h2" on the bind line.
13930
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013931ssl
13932 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013933 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013934 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13935 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013936 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13937 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013938
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013939ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13940 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013941 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13942 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13943 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013944 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13945
13946ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013947 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13948 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13949 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13950 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013951
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013952strict-sni
13953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13954 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13955 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13956 See the "crt" option for more information.
13957
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013958tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013959 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013960 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013961 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013962 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013963 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13964 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13965 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13966 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13967 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13968 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13969 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13970
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013971tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013972 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013973 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13974 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13975 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13976 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13977 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13978 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13979 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013980 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13981 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13982 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013983
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013984tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13985 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013986 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13987 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13988 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13989 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13990 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13991 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13992 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13993 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13994 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13995 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013996 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13997 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13998
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013999transparent
14000 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14001 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14002 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14003 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14004 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14005 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14006 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14007 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14008 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14009 so check for support with your vendor.
14010
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014011v4v6
14012 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14013 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14014 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14015 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014016 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014017
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014018v6only
14019 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14020 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14021 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014022 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14023 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014024
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014025uid <uid>
14026 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14027 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14028 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14029 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14030 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14031
14032user <user>
14033 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14034 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14035 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14036 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14037 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14038
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014039verify [none|optional|required]
14040 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14041 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14042 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14043 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14044 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014045 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14046 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14047 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14048 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014049
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140505.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014051------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014053The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14054which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14055arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14056settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14057after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14058Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14059address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014061 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014062 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014063
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014064Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14065keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014067The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014068
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014069addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014070 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014071 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14072 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14073 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14074 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14075 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014076
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014077agent-check
14078 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014079 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014080 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14081 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14082 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014084 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014085 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014086 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014087 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14088 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014089
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014090 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14091 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14092 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14093 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14094 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014095
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014096 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014098
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014099 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14100 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14101 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014102
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014103 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14104 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14105 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014106
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014107 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014108 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14109 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14110 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14111 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014112 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014113 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014114
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014115 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14116 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014117
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014118 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14119 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14120 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14121 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14122 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14123 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14124 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14125 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14126 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014127
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014128 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14129 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014130 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14131 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14132 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014133 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014134
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014135 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014136 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014137
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014138agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014139 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014140 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14141 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14142 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14143 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14144
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014145agent-inter <delay>
14146 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14147 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14148
14149 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14150 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14151 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14152 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14153 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14154 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14155 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14156 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14157 of backends use the same servers.
14158
14159 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14160
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014161agent-addr <addr>
14162 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14163
14164 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014165 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014166 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14167 hostname, it will be resolved.
14168
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014169agent-port <port>
14170 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14171
14172 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14173
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014174allow-0rtt
14175 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014176 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14177 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014178
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014179alpn <protocols>
14180 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14181 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14182 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014183 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014184 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14185 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14186 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14187 now obsolete NPN extension.
14188 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14189 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14190
14191 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014193backup
14194 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14195 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14196 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14197 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014198 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14199 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014200
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014201ca-file <cafile>
14202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14203 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14204 server's certificate.
14205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014206check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014207 This option enables health checks on a server:
14208 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14209 considered available.
14210 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14211 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14212 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14213 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14214 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14215 set.
14216 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14217 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14218 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14219 exchanges succeed.
14220
14221 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14222 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14223 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14224 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14225 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014226 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014227 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14228
14229 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14230 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14231
14232 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14233 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14234
14235 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14236 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14237 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14238 available.
14239
14240 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14241 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14242 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14243
14244 Example:
14245 # simple tcp check
14246 backend foo
14247 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14248 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14249 backend foo
14250 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14251 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14252 backend foo
14253 option tcp-check
14254 tcp-check connect
14255 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014256
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014257check-send-proxy
14258 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14259 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14260 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14261 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14262 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14263 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14264 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14265
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014266check-alpn <protocols>
14267 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14268 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14269 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14270
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014271check-proto <name>
14272 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14273 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14274 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014275 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14276 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14277
14278 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14279 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14280 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14281 also reported (flag=HTX).
14282
14283 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14284 directive on a server line:
14285
14286 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14287 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14288 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14289 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14290
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014291 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014292 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14293 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14294
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014295check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014296 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014297 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14298 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014299
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014300check-ssl
14301 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14302 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14303 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14304 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014305 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014306 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14307 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014308 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014309 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14310 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014311
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014312check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014313 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014314 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14315 for normal traffic.
14316
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014317ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14319 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14320 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014321 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14322 information and recommendations see e.g.
14323 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14324 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14325 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014326
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014327ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14329 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14330 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14331 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014332 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14333 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14334 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014336cookie <value>
14337 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14338 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14339 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14340 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14341 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14342 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14343 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14344
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014345crl-file <crlfile>
14346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14347 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14348 to verify server's certificate.
14349
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014350crt <cert>
14351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14352 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14353 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14354 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14355 certificate request.
14356
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014357 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14358 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14359 option is set accordingly).
14360
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014361disabled
14362 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14363 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14364 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14365 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14366 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014367 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014368
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014369enabled
14370 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14371 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14372 default value.
14373 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14374 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014376error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014377 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14378 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14379 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014381 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014383fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014384 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14385 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14386 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14387
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014388force-sslv3
14389 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14390 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014391 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014392 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014393
14394force-tlsv10
14395 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014396 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014397 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014398
14399force-tlsv11
14400 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014401 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014402 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014403
14404force-tlsv12
14405 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014406 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014407 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014408
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014409force-tlsv13
14410 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14411 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014412 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014414id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014415 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14416 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14417 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014418
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014419init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14420 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14421 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014422 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014423 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14424 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14425 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14426 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14427 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14428 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14429 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14430 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14431 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014432 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014433 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14434 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14435 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14436 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14437 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14438 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014439 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014440
14441 Example:
14442 defaults
14443 # never fail on address resolution
14444 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014446inter <delay>
14447fastinter <delay>
14448downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014449 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14450 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14451 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14452 between checks depending on the server state :
14453
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014454 Server state | Interval used
14455 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14456 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14457 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14458 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14459 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14460 or yet unchecked. |
14461 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14462 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14463 | "inter" otherwise.
14464 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014466 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14467 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14468 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14469 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014470 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14471 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14472 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14473 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14474 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014475
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014476log-proto <logproto>
14477 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14478 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14479 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14480 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014482maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014483 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14484 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014485 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14486 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014487 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14488 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14489 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14490 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14491
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014492 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14493 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14494 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14495 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14496 than 50 concurrent requests.
14497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014498maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014499 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14500 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14501 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14502 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014503 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14504 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14505 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14506 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14507 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14508 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14509 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014510
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014511max-reuse <count>
14512 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14513 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14514 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14515 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14516 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14517 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14518 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14519 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014521minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014522 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14523 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14524 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14525 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14526 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14527 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014528 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014529 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014530
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014531namespace <name>
14532 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14533 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14534 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14535 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14536
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014537no-agent-check
14538 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14539 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14540 default value.
14541 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14542 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14543
14544no-backup
14545 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14546 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14547 default value.
14548 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14549 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14550
14551no-check
14552 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14553 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14554 default value.
14555 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14556 "default-server" "check" setting.
14557
14558no-check-ssl
14559 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14560 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14561 default value.
14562 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14563 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14564
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014565no-send-proxy
14566 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14567 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14568 default value.
14569 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14570 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14571
14572no-send-proxy-v2
14573 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14574 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14575 default value.
14576 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14577 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14578
14579no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14580 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14581 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14582 default value.
14583 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14584 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14585
14586no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14587 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14588 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14589 default value.
14590 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14591 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14592
14593no-ssl
14594 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14595 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14596 default value.
14597 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14598 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14599
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014600 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14601 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14602 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14603
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014604no-ssl-reuse
14605 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14606 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14607 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14608 and for paranoid users.
14609
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014610no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014611 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14612 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014613 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014614
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014615 Supported in default-server: No
14616
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014617no-tls-tickets
14618 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14619 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14620 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014621 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14622 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014623 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14624 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14625 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014626 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014627
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014628no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014629 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014630 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14631 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014632 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14633 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014634 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014635
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014636 Supported in default-server: No
14637
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014638no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014639 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014640 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14641 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014642 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14643 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014644 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014645
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014646 Supported in default-server: No
14647
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014648no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014649 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014650 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14651 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014652 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14653 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014654 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014655
14656 Supported in default-server: No
14657
14658no-tlsv13
14659 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14660 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14661 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14662 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14663 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014664 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014665
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014666 Supported in default-server: No
14667
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014668no-verifyhost
14669 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14670 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14671 default value.
14672 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14673 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014674
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014675no-tfo
14676 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14677 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14678 default value.
14679 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14680 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14681
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014682non-stick
14683 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14684 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14685 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14686
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014687npn <protocols>
14688 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14689 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14690 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014691 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014692 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14693 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14694 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14695
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014696observe <mode>
14697 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14698 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14699 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14700 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14701 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14702 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014703 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014704
14705 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014707on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014708 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14709 Currently, four modes are available:
14710 - fastinter: force fastinter
14711 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14712 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14713 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14714 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14715
14716 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14717
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014718on-marked-down <action>
14719 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14720 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014721 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14722 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14723 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14724 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14725 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14726 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14727 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14728 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014729
14730 Actions are disabled by default
14731
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014732on-marked-up <action>
14733 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14734 Currently one action is available:
14735 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14736 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14737 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14738 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014739 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14740 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014741 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14742 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14743
14744 Actions are disabled by default
14745
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014746pool-low-conn <max>
14747 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14748 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14749 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14750 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14751 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14752 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14753 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14754 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14755 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14756 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014757 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14758 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14759 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14760 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014761
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014762pool-max-conn <max>
14763 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14764 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14765 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14766 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14767 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14768 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14769
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014770pool-purge-delay <delay>
14771 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014772 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014773 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014775port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014776 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014777 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14778 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14779 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14780 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14781 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014782
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014783proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014784 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14785 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14786 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014787 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14788 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14789
14790 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14791 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14792 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14793 also reported (flag=HTX).
14794
14795 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14796 a server line :
14797
14798 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14799 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14800 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14801 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14802
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014803 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014804 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14805
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014806redir <prefix>
14807 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14808 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14809 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14810 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14811 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14812 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14813 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14814 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014815 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014816 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014817 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14818 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14819 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14820 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14821
14822 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014824rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014825 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14826 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14827 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14828
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014829resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14830 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14831 server.
14832
14833 Available options:
14834
14835 * allow-dup-ip
14836 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14837 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14838 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14839 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14840 For such case, simply enable this option.
14841 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14842
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014843 * ignore-weight
14844 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14845 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14846 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14847
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014848 * prevent-dup-ip
14849 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14850 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14851 same fqdn.
14852 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14853
14854 Example:
14855 backend b_myapp
14856 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14857 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14858 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14859
14860 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14861 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14862 it
14863 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14864 different address
14865
14866 Default value: not set
14867
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014868resolve-prefer <family>
14869 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14870 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14871 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14872 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14873
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014874 Default value: ipv6
14875
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014876 Example:
14877
14878 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014879
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014880resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014881 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014882 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014883 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014884 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14885 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014886 configured network, another address is selected.
14887
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014888 Example:
14889
14890 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014891
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014892resolvers <id>
14893 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14894 hostname.
14895
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014896 Example:
14897
14898 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014899
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014900 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014901
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014902send-proxy
14903 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14904 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14905 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14906 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014907 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14908 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14909 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14910 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014911 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014912 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14913 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14914 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14915 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14916 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014917 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14918 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014919
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014920send-proxy-v2
14921 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14922 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14923 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14924 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014925 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14926 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14927 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14928 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014929
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014930proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014931 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14932 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14933
14934 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14935 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14936 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14937 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14938 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14939 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14940 connection is supported).
14941 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14942 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14943 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14944 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14945 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14946 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14947 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014948
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014949send-proxy-v2-ssl
14950 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14951 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14952 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14953 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14954 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14955 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14956 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014957 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14958 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014959
14960send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14961 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14962 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14963 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14964 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14965 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14966 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14967 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14968 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014969 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14970 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014971
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014972slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014973 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14974 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14975 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14976 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14977 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14978 parameters :
14979
14980 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14981 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14982
14983 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14984 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14985 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14986 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14987
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014988 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014989 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14990 seen as failed.
14991
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014992sni <expression>
14993 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14994 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14995 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14996 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014997 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14998 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014999 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015000 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15001 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015002
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015003source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015004source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015005source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015006 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15007 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15008 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15009 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15010
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015011 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15012 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15013 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15014 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15015 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15016 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15017 server.
15018
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015019 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15020 specifying the source address without port(s).
15021
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015022ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015023 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15024 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15025 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15026 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15027 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15028 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015029 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15030 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015031
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015032ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15033 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15034 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15035 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15036
15037ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15038 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15039 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15040 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15041
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015042ssl-reuse
15043 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15044 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15045 default value.
15046 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15047 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15048
15049stick
15050 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15051 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15052 default value.
15053 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15054 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015055
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015056socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015057 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015058 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15059 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15060
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015061tcp-ut <delay>
15062 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015063 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015064 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015065 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015066 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15067 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15068 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15069 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15070 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15071 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15072 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15073 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15074 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15075
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015076tfo
15077 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15078 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15079 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15080 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015081 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015082 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015084track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015085 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15086 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15087 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15088 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015089 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15090
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015091tls-tickets
15092 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15093 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15094 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015095 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15096 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15097 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015099 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015100
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015101verify [none|required]
15102 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015103 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015104 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15105 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015106 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015107 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15108 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15109 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15110 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15111 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15112 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15113 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15114 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015115
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015116verifyhost <hostname>
15117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015118 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15119 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15120 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15121 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15122 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15123 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15124 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15125 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015127weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015128 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15129 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15130 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015131 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15132 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15133 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15134 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15135 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15136 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015137
15138
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151395.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15140-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015141
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015142HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15143using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015144configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15146can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15147workload.
15148This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15149resolution at run time.
15150Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15151carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15152
15153
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151545.3.1. Global overview
15155----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015156
15157As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15158different steps of the process life:
15159
15160 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15161 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15162 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15163
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015164 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15165 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015166
15167A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15168 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15169 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15170 resolution to know this new IP.
15171
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015172When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015173HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015174SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15175from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015176will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015177will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015178
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015179A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015180 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015181 first valid response.
15182
15183 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15184 servers return an error.
15185
15186
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151875.3.2. The resolvers section
15188----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015189
15190This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15192contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015193
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015194When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15195uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15196is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15197answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15198
15199When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015200used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015201
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015202 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15203 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15204 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015205
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015206 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15207 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015208
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015209 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15210 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15211 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015212
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015213For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15214following scenarios are possible:
15215
15216 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15217 ignored
15218
15219 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15220 applied
15221
15222 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15223 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15224
15225 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15226 retries the query with a new type
15227
15228 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15229 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015230
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015231As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015232a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015233<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015234
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015235
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015236resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015237 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015238
15239A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15240
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015241accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015242 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015243 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015244 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15245 by RFC 6891)
15246
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015247 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15248 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15249 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15250 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15251 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15252 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015253
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015254nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15255 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15256 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15257 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15258 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15259 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15260 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15261 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15262 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15263 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015264 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15265
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015266parse-resolv-conf
15267 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15268 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15269 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15270
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015271hold <status> <period>
15272 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15273 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015274 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015275 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015276 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15277 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15278 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15279
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015280 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015281
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015282resolve_retries <nb>
15283 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15284 giving up.
15285 Default value: 3
15286
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015287 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15288 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15289 type.
15290
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015291timeout <event> <time>
15292 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15293 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15294 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015295 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15296 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015297 Default value: 1s
15298 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015299 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015300 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015301 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15302 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15303
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015304 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015305
15306 resolvers mydns
15307 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15308 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015309 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015310 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015311 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015312 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015313 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015314 hold other 30s
15315 hold refused 30s
15316 hold nx 30s
15317 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015318 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015319 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015320
15321
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153226. Cache
15323---------
15324
15325HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15326(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15327RAM.
15328
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015329The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15330blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015331
15332If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15333independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15334when we try to allocate a new one.
15335
15336The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15337
15338It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15339"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15340for more details.
15341
15342When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15343replaced by "<CACHE>".
15344
15345
153466.1. Limitation
15347----------------
15348
15349The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15350
15351- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015352- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15353 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15354 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015355- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15356- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015357- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15358 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15359 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015360- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15361 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015362- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15363 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15364 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015365
15366- If the request is not a GET
15367- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15368- If the request contains an Authorization header
15369
15370
153716.2. Setup
15372-----------
15373
15374To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15375the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15376
15377
153786.2.1. Cache section
15379---------------------
15380
15381cache <name>
15382 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15383 size of cache is mandatory.
15384
15385total-max-size <megabytes>
15386 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15387 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15388
15389max-object-size <bytes>
15390 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15391 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15392 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15393
15394max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015395 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015396 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15397 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15398 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15399 default.
15400
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015401process-vary <on/off>
15402 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015403 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15404 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15405 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015406 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015407
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015408max-secondary-entries <number>
15409 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15410 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15411 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15412
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015413
154146.2.2. Proxy section
15415---------------------
15416
15417http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15418 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15419 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15420 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15421 after this one.
15422
15423http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15424 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15425 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15426 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15427 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15428
15429
15430Example:
15431
15432 backend bck1
15433 mode http
15434
15435 http-request cache-use foobar
15436 http-response cache-store foobar
15437 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15438
15439 cache foobar
15440 total-max-size 4
15441 max-age 240
15442
15443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154447. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15445----------------------------------
15446
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015447HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15449The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15450these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15451but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15452data called patterns.
15453
15454
154557.1. ACL basics
15456---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015457
15458The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15459content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15460from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15461simple :
15462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015464 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015465 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15466 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15469adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015470
15471In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015474
15475This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15476Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15477and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015478an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15479conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15480as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15481are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015482
15483ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15484'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15485which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15486
15487There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15488performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15491specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15492this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015493methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15494ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015495
15496Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15497 - boolean
15498 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15499 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15500 - string
15501 - data block
15502
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015503Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15504converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15505would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15506The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15507which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15508
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015509Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15510keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15511fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15512which are summarized in the table below :
15513
15514 +---------------------+-----------------+
15515 | Sample or converter | Default |
15516 | output type | matching method |
15517 +---------------------+-----------------+
15518 | boolean | bool |
15519 +---------------------+-----------------+
15520 | integer | int |
15521 +---------------------+-----------------+
15522 | ip | ip |
15523 +---------------------+-----------------+
15524 | string | str |
15525 +---------------------+-----------------+
15526 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15527 +---------------------+-----------------+
15528
15529Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15530matching method, see below.
15531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015532The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15533 - boolean
15534 - integer or integer range
15535 - IP address / network
15536 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15537 - regular expression
15538 - hex block
15539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015540The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15541
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015542 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15543 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015545 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015546 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015547 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015548 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015550The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15551read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15552if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15553lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15554will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15555beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015556a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15558exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15559
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015560The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15561parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15562ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15563a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15564check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15565
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015566The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15567socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15568file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15571loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15572
15573 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15574
15575In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15576the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15577case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15578as well.
15579
15580The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15581sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15582do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15583methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15584is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015585obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015586followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15587default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15588that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15589string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15590
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015591The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15592By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15593string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15594resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015595server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015596waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015597flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15598function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15601sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15602be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015603
15604 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15605 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15607 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15608 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15609 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015610
15611 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15612 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015614
15615 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015616 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015617
15618 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015620
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15623
15624 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15625 binary or string samples.
15626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15628 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15631 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15632 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15635 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15638 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15641 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15644 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015645 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015647 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15648 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15649 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015650
15651For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15652request, it is possible to do :
15653
15654 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15655
15656In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15657buffer, one would use the following acl :
15658
15659 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15660
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015661On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15662possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15663
15664 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015666All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15667criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15668method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15669to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15670criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15671the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015673If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015674the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15675For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15678 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15679 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15680 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015681
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015682
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015683The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15684types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15685combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15686brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15687default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 +-------------------------------------------------+
15690 | Input sample type |
15691 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015692 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15694 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15695 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015696 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015698 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015700 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015702 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015704 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015706 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015708 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015710 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015712 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015714 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015716 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15718 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015720
15721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157227.1.1. Matching booleans
15723------------------------
15724
15725In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15726Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15727When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15728that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15729
15730Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15731return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15732"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157357.1.2. Matching integers
15736------------------------
15737
15738Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15739enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15740to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15741
15742Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15743matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15744lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015745
15746For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15747unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15748representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15749
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015750As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15751two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15752instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15753ranges and operators.
15754
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015755For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015756operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15757Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15758of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015760Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015761
15762 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15763 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15764 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15765 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15766 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15767
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015768For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015769
15770 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15771
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015772This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15773
15774 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157777.1.3. Matching strings
15778-----------------------
15779
15780String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15781different forms :
15782
15783 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015784 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015785
15786 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015787 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788
15789 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15790 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15791
15792 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15793 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15794
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015795 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015796 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15797 matches.
15798
15799 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15800 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15801 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015802
15803String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15804exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15805characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15806string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15807to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015808before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015810Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15811(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15812Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15813
15814Example:
15815 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15816 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158197.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15820---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015821
15822Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15823they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15824possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15825passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15826the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015827the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15828match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015829
15830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158317.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15832-------------------------------------
15833
15834It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15835not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15836a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15837to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15838digits may be used upper or lower case.
15839
15840Example :
15841 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15842 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15843
15844
158457.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15846---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015847
15848IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15849netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15850within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015851host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015852difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15853at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15854does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15855parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015856
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015857The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15858abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15859
15860 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15861 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15862 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15863 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15864 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15865 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15866 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15867 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15868
15869Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15870192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15871
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015872IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15873Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15874trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15875IPv6 patterns.
15876
15877HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15878following situations :
15879 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15880 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15881 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15882 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15883 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15884 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15885 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15886 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15887 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15888 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890
158917.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15892----------------------------------
15893
15894Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15895combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15896
15897 - AND (implicit)
15898 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15899 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015901A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15906indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15909"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15910requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15911is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15912
15913 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015914 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15915 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15916 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917
15918To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15919and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15920
15921 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15922 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15923 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15924 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15925
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015926 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15928 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15929 use_backend www if host_www
15930
15931It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15932expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15933be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15934the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15935
15936 The following rule :
15937
15938 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015939 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940
15941 Can also be written that way :
15942
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015943 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944
15945It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15946to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15947simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15948sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15949good use is the following :
15950
15951 With named ACLs :
15952
15953 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15954 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15955 monitor fail if site_dead
15956
15957 With anonymous ACLs :
15958
15959 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15960
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015961See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15962keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963
15964
159657.3. Fetching samples
15966---------------------
15967
15968Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15969against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15970sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15971ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15972of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15973available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15974
15975This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15976Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15977compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15978deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15979
15980The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15981matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15982method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15983indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15984
15985As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15986when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15987mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15988the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15989ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15990
15991Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15992multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15993when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015994incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15995are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15997all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15998
15999Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16000 - name
16001 - name(arg1)
16002 - name(arg1,arg2)
16003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016004
160057.3.1. Converters
16006-----------------
16007
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016008Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16009of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16010is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16011was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016012has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016013unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16014
16015These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16016sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16017the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016018support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016019
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016020A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16021support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16022supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16023(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16024bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016027
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001602851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16029 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16030 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16031 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16032 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16033 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16034
16035 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016036 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16037 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016038 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16039 frontend http-in
16040 bind *:8081
16041 default_backend servers
16042 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16043 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16044
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016045add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016046 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016047 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016048 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16049 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016050 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016051 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16052 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16053 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16054 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016055 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016056 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016057
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016058aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16059 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16060 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16061 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16062 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16063 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16064 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16065
16066 Example:
16067 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16068 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16069
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016070and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016071 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016072 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016073 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16074 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016075 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16078 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16079 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016080 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016081 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016082
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016083b64dec
16084 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16085 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016086 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16087 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016088
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016089base64
16090 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016091 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016092 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16093 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016094
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016095be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16096 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16097 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16098 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16099 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16100 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16101
16102 Example:
16103 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16104 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16105 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16106 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16107
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016108bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016109 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016110 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016111 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016112 presence of a flag).
16113
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016114bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16115 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16116 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016117 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016118
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016119concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16120 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16121 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16122 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16123 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16124 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16125 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16126 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16127 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16128 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16129 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016130 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016131 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016132 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16133 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016134
16135 Example:
16136 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16137 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16138 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016139 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016140 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16141
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016142cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016143 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16144 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016145
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016146crc32([<avalanche>])
16147 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16148 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16149 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16150 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16151 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16152 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16153 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16154 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16155 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16156 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016157 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16158
16159crc32c([<avalanche>])
16160 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16161 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16162 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16163 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16164 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16165 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16166 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16167 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016168
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016169cut_crlf
16170 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16171 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16172 updated.
16173
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016174da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016175 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16176 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16177 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16178 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016179 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016180 configuration language.
16181
16182 Example:
16183 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016184 bind *:8881
16185 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016186 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016187
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016188debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16189 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16190 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16191 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16192 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16193 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16194 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16195 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16196 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16197 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16198 printable sample types.
16199
16200 Example:
16201 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016202
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016203digest(<algorithm>)
16204 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16205 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16206
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016207 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016208 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16209
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016210div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016211 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16212 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016213 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016214 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16215 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016216 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016217 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16218 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16219 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16220 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016222 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016223
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016224djb2([<avalanche>])
16225 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16226 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16227 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16228 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16229 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16230 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16231 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016232 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16233 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016234
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016235even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016236 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016237 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16238
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016239field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16240 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16241 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16242 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16243 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16244 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16245 fields.
16246
16247 Example :
16248 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16249 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16250 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16251 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16252 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016253
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016254fix_is_valid
16255 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16256 Information eXchange):
16257
16258 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16259 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016260 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016261 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016262 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016263 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16264 checksum
16265
16266 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16267 the server can be parsed.
16268
16269 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16270 message, false if not.
16271
16272 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16273
16274 Example:
16275 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16276 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16277
16278fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16279 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16280 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16281 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16282 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016283 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016284 added.
16285
16286 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16287 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16288 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16289 fix_is_valid converter.
16290
16291 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16292
16293 Example:
16294 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16295 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16296 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16297 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16298 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16299
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016300hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016301 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016302 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016303 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016304 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016305
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016306hex2i
16307 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016308 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016309
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016310htonl
16311 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16312 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16313 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16314 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16315
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016316hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016317 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16318 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16319 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16320 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16321
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016322 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016323 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16324
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016325http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016326 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16327 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016328 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16329 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16330 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16331 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16332 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16333 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16334 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16335 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016337iif(<true>,<false>)
16338 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16339 string otherwise.
16340
16341 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016342 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016343
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016344in_table(<table>)
16345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16347 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016348 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016349 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16350
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016351ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016352 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016353 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016354 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16355 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16356 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16357 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16358 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016359
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016360json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016361 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016362 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016363 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016364 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16365 of errors:
16366 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16367 bytes, ...)
16368 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16369 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16370
16371 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16372 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16373 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16374 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16375 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16376 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377 - "ascii" : never fails;
16378 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16379 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016380 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016381 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016382 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16383 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16384
16385 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016386 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016387
16388 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016389 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016390 capture request header user-agent len 150
16391 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016392
16393 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16394 GET / HTTP/1.0
16395 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16396
16397 Output log:
16398 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16399
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016400json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16401 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16402 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16403 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16404 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16405
16406 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16407 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16408
16409 Example:
16410 # get a integer value from the request body
16411 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16412 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16413
16414 # get a key with '.' in the name
16415 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16416 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16417
16418 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16419 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16420
16421 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16422 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16423
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016424language(<value>[,<default>])
16425 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16426 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16427 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16428 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16429 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16430 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16431 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16432 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16433 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016434 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016435 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16436 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016437
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016438 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016439
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016440 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16441 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016443 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16444 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16445 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16446 use_backend spanish if es
16447 use_backend french if fr
16448 use_backend english if en
16449 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016450
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016451length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016452 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16453 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16454 type. The result is of type integer.
16455
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016456lower
16457 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16458 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16459 type. The result is of type string.
16460
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016461ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16462 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16463 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16464 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16465 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16466 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16467 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16468
16469 Example :
16470
16471 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016472 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016473 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16474
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016475ltrim(<chars>)
16476 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16477 representation of the input sample.
16478
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016479map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16480map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16481map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16482 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16483 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16484 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16485 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16486 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16487 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16488 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16489 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016490
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016491 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16492 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16493 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016494
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016495 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016496 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016497
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016498 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16500 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016502 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016504 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16506 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16508 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16509 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16510 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16511 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016512 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16513 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16514 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16516 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16518 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016520
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016521 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16522 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16523 the corresponding match text.
16524
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016525 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16526 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16527 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16528 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16529 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016530
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 Example :
16532
16533 # this is a comment and is ignored
16534 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16535 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16536 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16537 | | | `---------- value
16538 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16539 | `---------------------------- key
16540 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16541
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016542mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016543 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16544 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016545 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016546 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016547 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016548 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16549 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16550 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16551 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016552 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016553 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016554
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016555mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016556 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16557 <packettype>.
16558 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16559 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16560 from.
16561 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16562 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16563 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16564
16565 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16566 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16567 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16568 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16569
16570 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16571 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16572 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16573 packets only):
16574 17: Session Expiry Interval
16575 33: Receive Maximum
16576 39: Maximum Packet Size
16577 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16578 25: Request Response Information
16579 23: Request Problem Information
16580 21: Authentication Method
16581 22: Authentication Data
16582 18: Will Delay Interval
16583 1: Payload Format Indicator
16584 2: Message Expiry Interval
16585 3: Content Type
16586 8: Response Topic
16587 9: Correlation Data
16588 Not supported yet:
16589 38: User Property
16590
16591 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16592 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16593 packets only):
16594 17: Session Expiry Interval
16595 33: Receive Maximum
16596 36: Maximum QoS
16597 37: Retain Available
16598 39: Maximum Packet Size
16599 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16600 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16601 31: Reason String
16602 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16603 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16604 42: Shared Subscription Available
16605 19: Server Keep Alive
16606 26: Response Information
16607 28: Server Reference
16608 21: Authentication Method
16609 22: Authentication Data
16610 Not supported yet:
16611 38: User Property
16612
16613 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16614 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16615 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16616 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16617
16618 Example:
16619
16620 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16621 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16622 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16623 if data_in_buffer
16624 # do the same as above
16625 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16626 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16627 if data_in_buffer
16628
16629mqtt_is_valid
16630 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16631
16632 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16633 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16634 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16635 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16636
16637 Example:
16638
16639 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016640 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016641
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016642mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016643 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016644 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16645 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016646 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016647 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16650 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16651 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16652 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016654 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016655
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016656nbsrv
16657 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16658 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16659 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16660 map lookup.
16661
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016662neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016663 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16664 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16665 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16666 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016667
16668not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016669 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016670 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016671 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016672 absence of a flag).
16673
16674odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016675 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016676 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16677
16678or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016679 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016680 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016681 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16682 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016683 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016684 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16685 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16686 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16687 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016688 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016689 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016690
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016691protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16692 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16693 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16694 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16695 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16696 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16697 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16698 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16699 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16700 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16701 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16702 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16703
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016704regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016705 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16706 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16707 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16708 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16709 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16710 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16711 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16712 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16713 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016714 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16715 of characters with other ones.
16716
16717 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16718 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16719 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16720 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16721 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16722 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016723
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016724 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016725
16726 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16727 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16728 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016729 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016730
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016731 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16732 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16733
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016734 # capture groups and backreferences
16735 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016736 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016737 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16738
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016739capture-req(<id>)
16740 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16741 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16742
16743 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016744 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16745 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016746
16747capture-res(<id>)
16748 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16749 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16750
16751 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016752 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16753 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016754
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016755rtrim(<chars>)
16756 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16757 of the input sample.
16758
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016759sdbm([<avalanche>])
16760 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16761 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16762 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16763 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16764 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16765 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16766 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016767 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16768 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016769
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016770secure_memcmp(<var>)
16771 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16772 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16773 match.
16774
16775 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16776 performed in constant time.
16777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016778 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016779 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16780
16781 Example :
16782
16783 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16784 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16785 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16786 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16787
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016788set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016789 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16790 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16791 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016792 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016793 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16794 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016795 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016796 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16797 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016798 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016799 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016800
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016801sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016802 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016803 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16804
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016805sha2([<bits>])
16806 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16807 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16808
16809 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16810 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16811
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016812 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016813 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16814
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016815srv_queue
16816 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16817 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16818 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16819 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16820 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16821
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016822strcmp(<var>)
16823 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16824 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16825 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16826 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16827 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16828 shorter).
16829
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016830 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16831 strings in constant time.
16832
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016833 Example :
16834
16835 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16836 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16837 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16838
16839
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016840sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016841 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16842 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016843 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016844 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16845 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016846 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016847 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16848 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016849 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016850 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16851 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016853 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016854
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016855table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16859 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16860 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16861 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16862
16863
16864table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16868 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16869 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16870 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16871
16872table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016876 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16877 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16878
16879table_conn_cur(<table>)
16880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16883 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16884 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16885
16886table_conn_rate(<table>)
16887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16890 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16891 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16892
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016893table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16897 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16898 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16899 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16900 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16901 data-type).
16902 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16903
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016904table_gpt0(<table>)
16905 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16906 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16907 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16908 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16909 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16910
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016911table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16912 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16913 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16914 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16915 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16916 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16917 between 0 and 99.
16918 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16919 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16920 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16921 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16922
16923table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16927 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16928 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16929 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16930 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16931 value 0.
16932 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16933 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16934 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16935
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016936table_gpc0(<table>)
16937 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16938 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16939 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16940 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16941 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16942
16943table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16944 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16945 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16946 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16947 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16948 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16949 sample fetch keyword.
16950
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016951table_gpc1(<table>)
16952 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16953 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16954 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16955 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16956 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16957
16958table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16959 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16960 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16961 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16962 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16963 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16964 sample fetch keyword.
16965
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016966table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016969 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016970 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16971 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16972
16973table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16976 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16977 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16978 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16979 keyword.
16980
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016981table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16985 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16986 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16987
16988table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16991 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16992 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16993 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16994 keyword.
16995
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016996table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017000 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17001 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17002
17003table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17006 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17007 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17008 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17009 keyword.
17010
17011table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017015 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17016 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17017 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17018 keyword.
17019
17020table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017024 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17025 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17026 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17027 keyword.
17028
17029table_server_id(<table>)
17030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17033 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17034 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17035 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17036
17037table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17038 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17039 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017040 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017041 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17042 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17043 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17044 keyword.
17045
17046table_sess_rate(<table>)
17047 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17048 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17049 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17050 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17051 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17052 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17053 keyword.
17054
17055table_trackers(<table>)
17056 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17057 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17058 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17059 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17060 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17061 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17062 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17063 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17064 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17065 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17066
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017067ub64dec
17068 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17069 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17070 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17071
17072 Example:
17073 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17074 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17075
17076ub64enc
17077 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17078
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017079upper
17080 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17081 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17082 type. The result is of type string.
17083
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017084url_dec([<in_form>])
17085 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17086 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17087 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17088 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17089 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17090 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017091
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017092url_enc([<enc_type>])
17093 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17094 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17095 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17096 optional argument is here for future changes.
17097
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017098ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017099 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017100 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17101 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17102 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017103 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17104 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17105 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17106 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017107 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017108 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17109 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017110
17111 Example:
17112 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17113 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17114
17115 message Point {
17116 int32 latitude = 1;
17117 int32 longitude = 2;
17118 }
17119
17120 message PPoint {
17121 Point point = 59;
17122 }
17123
17124 message Rectangle {
17125 // One corner of the rectangle.
17126 PPoint lo = 48;
17127 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17128 PPoint hi = 49;
17129 }
17130
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017131 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17132 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17133 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017134
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017135 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17136 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017137 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017138 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17139
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017140 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017141
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017142 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017143
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017144 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17145 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17146 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017147
17148 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17149 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17150 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17151
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017152 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17153 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17154 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017155
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017156
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017157unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017158 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17159 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17160 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17161 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17162 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17163 response),
17164 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17165 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17166 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17167 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17168
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017169utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17170 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17171 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17172 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17173 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17174 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17175 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17176
17177 Example :
17178
17179 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017180 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017181 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17182
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017183word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17184 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17185 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17186 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017187 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017188 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17189 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17190
17191 Example :
17192 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17193 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17194 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17195 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17196 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017197 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017198
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017199wt6([<avalanche>])
17200 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17201 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17202 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17203 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17204 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17205 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17206 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017207 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17208 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017209
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017210xor(<value>)
17211 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017212 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017213 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017214 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017215 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017216 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17217 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017218 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017219 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17220 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017221 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017222 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017223
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017224xxh3([<seed>])
17225 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17226 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17227 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17228 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17229 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17230 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17231 considered as cryptographically secure.
17232
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017233xxh32([<seed>])
17234 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17235 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17236 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17237 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17238 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17239 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17240 as cryptographically secure.
17241
17242xxh64([<seed>])
17243 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17244 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17245 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17246 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17247 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17248 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17249 as cryptographically secure.
17250
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172527.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017253--------------------------------------------
17254
17255A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17256not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17257"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17258The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17259
17260always_false : boolean
17261 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17262 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17263
17264always_true : boolean
17265 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17266 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17267
17268avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017269 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17271 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17272 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17273 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17274 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17275 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17276 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17277 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17278 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17279 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17280 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17281 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17282 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017284be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017285 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17286 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17287 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17288 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017289 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17290
17291be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17292 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17293 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17294 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17295 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17296 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017297 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17298 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017299
17300 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17301 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17302 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017304be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17306 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17307 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017308 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17310 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017311
17312 Example :
17313 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17314 backend dynamic
17315 mode http
17316 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17317 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017318
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017319bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017320 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17321 of the string.
17322
17323bool(<bool>) : bool
17324 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17325 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017329 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17331 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017332
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017333 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017334 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017335 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17336
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017337 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17338 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017339
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017340 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017341 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017343 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017344 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017345 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017346 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017347
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017348 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17349 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017351 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017352
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017353cpu_calls : integer
17354 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17355 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17356 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17357 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17358 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17359 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17360
17361cpu_ns_avg : integer
17362 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17363 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17364 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17365 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17366 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17367 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17368 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17369 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17370 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17371 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17372 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17373
17374cpu_ns_tot : integer
17375 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17376 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17377 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17378 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17379 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17380 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17381 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17382 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17383 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17384 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17385 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17386 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17387 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17388
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017389date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017390 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017391
17392 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17393 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17394 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017395 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17396
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017397 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17398 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17399 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17400 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17401 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17402
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017403 Example :
17404
17405 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17406 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017407
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017408 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17409 # millisecond granularity
17410 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17411
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017412date_us : integer
17413 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17414 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17415 from the same timeval structure.
17416
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017417distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17418 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17419 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17420 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17421 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017422 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017423 list of supported tokens.
17424
17425distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17426 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17427 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17428 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17429 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017430 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017431 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17432 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17433 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17434 supported tokens.
17435
17436 Example :
17437 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17438 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17439 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17440 # send large files to the big farm
17441 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17442
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017443env(<name>) : string
17444 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17445 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17446 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17447 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17448 certain way.
17449
17450 Examples :
17451 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17452 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17453
17454 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17455 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17458 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017459 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17460 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017461 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17462 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017463 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017464 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17465 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017466
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017467fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17468 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17469 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17470 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17473 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17474 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17475 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17476 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17477 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17478 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17479 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17480 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017481
17482 Example :
17483 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17484 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17485 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17486 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17487 frontend mail
17488 bind :25
17489 mode tcp
17490 maxconn 100
17491 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17492 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17493 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17494 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017495
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017496hostname : string
17497 Returns the system hostname.
17498
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017499int(<integer>) : signed integer
17500 Returns a signed integer.
17501
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017502ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17503 Returns an ipv4.
17504
17505ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17506 Returns an ipv6.
17507
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017508lat_ns_avg : integer
17509 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17510 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17511 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17512 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17513 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17514 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17515 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17516 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17517 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017518 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17519 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17520 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17521 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17522 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17523 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017524
17525lat_ns_tot : integer
17526 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17527 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17528 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17529 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17530 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17531 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17532 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17533 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17534 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017535 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17536 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17537 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17538 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17539 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017540 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17541 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17542 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17543 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17544 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17545 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17546
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017547meth(<method>) : method
17548 Returns a method.
17549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17551 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17552 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17553 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017554 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17555 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17556 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017557
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017558prio_class : integer
17559 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17560 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17561 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17562
17563prio_offset : integer
17564 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17565 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17566 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17567 set-priority-offset".
17568
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017569proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017570 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17571 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017574 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17575 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17576 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17578 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17579 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17580 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17581 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17582
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017583rand([<range>]) : integer
17584 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17585 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17586 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17587 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17588 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17592 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17593 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17594 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17595 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017596 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17597 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17598
17599srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17601 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17602 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17603 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17604 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17605 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17606 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17607
17608 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17609 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017610
17611srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17612 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17613 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17614 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17617 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17618 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17619
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017620srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17621 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17622 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17623 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17624 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17625 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17626 fetch methods.
17627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017628srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17629 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17630 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017631 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17633 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017634 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635 overloading servers).
17636
17637 Example :
17638 # Redirect to a separate back
17639 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17640 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17641 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17642
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017643srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017644 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17645 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17646 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17647
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017648srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017649 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17650 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17651 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17652
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017653srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017654 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17655 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17656 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17657
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017658stopping : boolean
17659 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17660 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17661 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17662
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017663str(<string>) : string
17664 Returns a string.
17665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017666table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17667 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17668 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17669
17670table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17671 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17672 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17673 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17674
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017675thread : integer
17676 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17677 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17678 and debugging purposes.
17679
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017680uuid([<version>]) : string
17681 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17682 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17683 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17684
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017685var(<var-name>) : undefined
17686 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017687 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17688 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017692 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017693 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17694 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017695 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017696 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699----------------------------------
17700
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017701The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17703methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17704sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17705TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017706the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17707counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017708"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17709used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17710can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17711Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17712table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17713tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17714currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017715
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017716bc_dst : ip
17717 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17718 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17719 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17720 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17721
17722bc_dst_port : integer
17723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017724 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017725
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017726bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017727 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17728 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17729 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17730
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017731bc_src : ip
17732 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017733 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017734 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17735 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17736
17737bc_src_port : integer
17738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017739 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017741be_id : integer
17742 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017743 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17744 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017746be_name : string
17747 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017748 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17749 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017750
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017751be_server_timeout : integer
17752 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17753 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17754 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17755
17756be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17757 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17758 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17759 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17760
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017761cur_server_timeout : integer
17762 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17763 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17764 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17765
17766cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17767 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17768 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17769 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771dst : ip
17772 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17773 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17774 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17775 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017776 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17777 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17778 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17779 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17780 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17781 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782
17783dst_conn : integer
17784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17785 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17786 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17787 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17788 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17789 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17790 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17791 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017792
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017793dst_is_local : boolean
17794 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17795 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17796 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17797 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017798 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017799 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17800 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17801 it only once per connection.
17802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017803dst_port : integer
17804 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17805 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17806 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17807 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17808 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17809 an HTTP header.
17810
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017811fc_conn_err : integer
17812 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17813 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17814 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017815 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017816 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17817
17818fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017819 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017820 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17821 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17822 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17823
17824 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17825 | ID | message |
17826 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17827 | 0 | "Success" |
17828 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17829 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17830 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17831 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17832 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17833 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17834 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17835 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17836 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17837 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17838 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17839 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17840 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17841 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17842 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17843 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17844 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17845 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17846 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17847 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17848 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17849 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17850 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17851 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17852 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17853 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17854 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17855 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17856 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17857 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17858 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17859 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17860 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17861 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17862 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17863 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17864 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17865 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17866 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17867 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17868 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17869 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17870 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17871
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017872fc_http_major : integer
17873 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17874 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17875 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17876
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017877fc_pp_authority : string
17878 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17879 if any.
17880
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017881fc_pp_unique_id : string
17882 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17883 if any.
17884
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017885fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17886 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17887 header.
17888
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017889fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17890 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17891 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17892 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17893 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17894 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17895 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17896
17897fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17898 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17899 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17900 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17901 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17902 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17903 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17904
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017905fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017906 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17907 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17908 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17909 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17910
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017911fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017912 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17913 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17914 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17915 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17916
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017917fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017918 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17919 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17920 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17921 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17922
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017923fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017924 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17925 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17926 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17927 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17928
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017929fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017930 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17931 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17932 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17933 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17934
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017935fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017936 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17937 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17938 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17939 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17940
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017941fe_defbe : string
17942 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17943 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017945fe_id : integer
17946 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017947 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017948 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17949
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017950fe_name : string
17951 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17952 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17953 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17954
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017955fe_client_timeout : integer
17956 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17957 current frontend.
17958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017959sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017960sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17961sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17962sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017963 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17964 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17965 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017967sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017968sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17969sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17970sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017971 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17972 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17973 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17974
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017975sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17976 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
17977 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
17978 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
17979 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
17980 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
17981 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
17982 will always return zero.
17983 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17984 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017986sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017987sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17988sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17989sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017990 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17991 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017992 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17993 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17994 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017995
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017996 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017997 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17998 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017999 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18000 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18001 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018002 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18003 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18004
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018005sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18006sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18007sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18008sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18009 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18010 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18011 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18012 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18013 when a first ACL was verified.
18014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018015sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018016sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18017sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18018sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018019 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018020 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18021
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018022sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018023sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18024sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18025sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018026 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18027 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18028 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018030sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018031sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18032sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18033sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018034 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18035 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18036 See also src_conn_rate.
18037
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018038sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18039 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18040 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18041 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18042 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18043 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18044 index, zero is returned.
18045 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18046 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18047
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018048sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018049sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18050sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18051sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018052 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018053 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018054
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018055sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18056sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18057sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18058sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18059 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18060 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18061
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018062sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18063 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18064 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18065 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18066 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18067 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18068 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18069 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18070
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018071sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18072sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18073sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18074sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18075 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18076 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18077
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018078sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18079 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18080 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18081 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18082 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18083 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18084 between 0 and 2.
18085 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18086 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18087 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18088 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18089 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18090
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018091sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018092sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18093sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18094sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018095 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18096 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18097 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018098 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18099 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18100 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018101
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018102sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18103sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18104sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18105sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18106 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18107 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18108 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18109 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18110 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18111 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18112
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018113sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018114sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18115sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18116sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018117 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018118 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18119 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18120
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018121sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018122sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18124sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018125 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18126 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18127 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18128 src_http_err_rate.
18129
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018130sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18131sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18132sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18133sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18134 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18135 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18136 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18137
18138sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18139sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18140sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18141sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18142 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18143 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18144 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18145 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018147sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018148sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018151 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018152 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18153 src_http_req_cnt.
18154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018155sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018156sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18157sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18158sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018159 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18160 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18161 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18162 src_http_req_rate.
18163
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018164sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18165 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18166 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18167 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18168 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18169 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18170 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18171 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18172 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18173 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18174
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018175sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018176sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18177sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18178sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018179 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018180 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18181 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18182 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18183 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018184
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018185 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018186 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18187 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018188 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18189
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018190sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18191sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18192sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18193sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18194 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18195 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18196 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18197 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18198 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18199
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018200sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018201sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18202sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18203sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018204 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18205 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18206 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018208sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018209sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18210sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18211sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018212 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18213 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18214 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018216sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018217sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18218sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18219sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018220 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018221 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18222 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18223 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018224 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018225 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18226
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018227sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018228sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18229sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18230sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018231 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18232 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18233 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18234 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18235 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018236 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018237
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018238sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018239sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18240sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18241sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018242 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18243 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18244 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18245
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018246sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018247sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18248sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18249sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018250 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18251 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018252 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018253 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18254 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18256 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18257 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259so_id : integer
18260 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18261 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18262 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018263
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018264so_name : string
18265 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18266 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18267 strings instead of integers.
18268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018269src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018270 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18272 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18273 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018274 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18275 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18276 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018277 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18278 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18279 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18280 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18281 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18282 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18283 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018284
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018285 Example:
18286 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18287 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18290 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18291 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18292 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018293 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018295src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18296 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18297 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018298 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018299 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018300
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018301src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18302 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18303 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18304 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18305 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18306 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18307 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18308 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18309 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18312 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18313 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18314 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18315 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18316 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18317 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018318
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018319 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018320 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18321 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18322 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18323 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018324 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018325 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18326 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18327
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018328src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18329 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18330 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18331 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18332 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18333 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18334 was verified.
18335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018337 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018339 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018340 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018342src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018343 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018344 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18345 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018346 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018348src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18349 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18350 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18351 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018352 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018353
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018354src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18355 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18356 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18357 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18358 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18359 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18360 is returned.
18361 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18362 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18363 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018366 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018368 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018369 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018371src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18372 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18373 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18374 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18375 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18376
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018377src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18378 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18379 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18380 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18381 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18382 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18383 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18384
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018385src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18386 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18387 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18388 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18389 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18390
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018391src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18392 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18393 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18394 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18395 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18396 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18397 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18398 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18399 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18400 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18401 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018403src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018404 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018405 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018406 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18407 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018408 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18409 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18410 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018411
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018412src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18413 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18414 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18415 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18416 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18417 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18418 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18419 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018421src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018422 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018424 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018425 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018428src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18429 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18430 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18431 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18432 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018433 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018434
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018435src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18436 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18437 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018438 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018439 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18440 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18441
18442src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18443 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18444 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18445 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18446 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18447 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18448 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018450src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018451 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018452 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18453 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018454 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18457 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18458 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18459 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018460 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018461 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018462
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018463src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18464 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18465 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18466 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18467 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18468 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18469 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18470 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18471 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018473src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18474 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18475 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18476 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018477 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018478 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18479 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018480
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018481 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018482 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018483 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018484 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018485
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018486src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18487 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18488 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18489 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18490 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18491 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18492 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18493
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018494src_is_local : boolean
18495 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18496 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18497 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18498 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018499 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018500 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18501 once per connection.
18502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018503src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018504 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18505 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18506 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18507 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18508 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018511 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18512 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18513 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18514 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18515 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018517src_port : integer
18518 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18519 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18520 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18521 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018524 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018525 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18526 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18527 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018528 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018530src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18531 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18532 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18533 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18534 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018535 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18538 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18539 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18540 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18541 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18542 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18543 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18544 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18545 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018546
18547 Example :
18548 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18549 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18550 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18551 listen ssh
18552 bind :22
18553 mode tcp
18554 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018555 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018556 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018557 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018559srv_id : integer
18560 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18561 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018562 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018563
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018564srv_name : string
18565 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18566 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018567 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185697.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018571
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018572The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018573closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18574when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18575usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018576future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018577
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001857851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18579 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18580 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18581 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18582 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18583 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18584
18585 Example :
18586 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18587 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18588 # the request.
18589 frontend http-in
18590 bind *:8081
18591 default_backend servers
18592 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18593 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18594
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018595ssl_bc : boolean
18596 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18597 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018598 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18599 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018600
18601ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18602 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018603 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18604 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018605
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018606ssl_bc_alpn : string
18607 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18608 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018609 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018610 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18611 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18612 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18613 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18614 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018615 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18616 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018617
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018618ssl_bc_cipher : string
18619 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018620 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18621 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018622
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018623ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18624 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18625 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18626 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018627 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018628
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018629ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18630 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18631 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018632 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18633 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018634
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018635ssl_bc_npn : string
18636 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18637 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018638 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018639 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18640 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18641 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18642 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018643 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18644 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018645
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018646ssl_bc_protocol : string
18647 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018648 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18649 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018650
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018651ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018652 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018653 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018654 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18655 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018656
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018657ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18658 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18659 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18660 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018661 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018662
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018663ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18664 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18665 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018666 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18667 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018668
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018669ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18670 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18671 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18672 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018673 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018674
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018675ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18676 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018677 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18678 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018680ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18681 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18682 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18683 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18684 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18685 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18688 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18689 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18690 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18691 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018692
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018693ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018694 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18695 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18696 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018697 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018698 does not support resumed sessions.
18699
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018700ssl_c_der : binary
18701 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18702 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18703 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705ssl_c_err : integer
18706 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18707 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18708 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18709 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18710 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018711
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018712ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18714 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18715 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18716 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18717 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18718 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18719 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18720 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018721 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18722 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18723 LDAP v3.
18724 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18725 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018727ssl_c_key_alg : string
18728 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18729 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18730 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732ssl_c_notafter : string
18733 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18734 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18735 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018737ssl_c_notbefore : string
18738 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18739 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18740 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018741
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018742ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18744 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18745 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18746 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18747 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18748 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18749 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18750 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018751 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18752 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18753 LDAP v3.
18754 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18755 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018757ssl_c_serial : binary
18758 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18759 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18760 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18763 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18764 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18765 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018766 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18767 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18768
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018769 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018770 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018772ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18773 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18774 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18775 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018777ssl_c_used : boolean
18778 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18779 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018781ssl_c_verify : integer
18782 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18783 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18784 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18785 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018787ssl_c_version : integer
18788 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18789 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018790
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018791ssl_f_der : binary
18792 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18793 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18794 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18795
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018796ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18798 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18799 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18800 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018801 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18803 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18804 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018805 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18806 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18807 LDAP v3.
18808 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18809 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018811ssl_f_key_alg : string
18812 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18813 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18814 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816ssl_f_notafter : string
18817 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18818 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18819 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018821ssl_f_notbefore : string
18822 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18823 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18824 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018825
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018826ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18828 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18829 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18830 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18831 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18832 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18833 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18834 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018835 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18836 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18837 LDAP v3.
18838 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18839 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018841ssl_f_serial : binary
18842 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18843 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18844 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018845
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018846ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18847 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18848 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18849 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018851ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18852 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18853 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18854 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018856ssl_f_version : integer
18857 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18858 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18859
18860ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018861 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18862 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18863 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865 Example :
18866 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18867 listen http-https
18868 bind :80
18869 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18870 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18871
18872ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18873 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18874 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18875
18876ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018877 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018878 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018879 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018880 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18881 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18882 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18883 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18884 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18885 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018887ssl_fc_cipher : string
18888 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18889 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018890
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018891ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18892 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18893 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
18894 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" setting. Setting
18895 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18896 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18897 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018898
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018899 Example:
18900 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18901 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18902 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18903 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18904 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18905 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18906 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18907 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18908 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18909
18910ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018911 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018912 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
18913 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size"
18914 setting. Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted
18915 values:
18916 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18917 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018918
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018919ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018920 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018921 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
18922 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" setting. Setting
18923 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18924 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18925 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18926 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
18927 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
18928 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018929
18930ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018931 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018932 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018933 take into account all the data of the cipher list.
18934
18935ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
18936 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
18937 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
18938 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" setting.
18939
18940 Example:
18941 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18942 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18943 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18944 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18945 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18946 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18947 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18948 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18949 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18950
18951ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18952 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
18953 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
18954 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" setting. Setting
18955 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18956 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
18957 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18958
18959 Example:
18960 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18961 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18962 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18963 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18964 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18965 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18966 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18967 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18968 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18969
18970ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18971 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
18972 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
18973 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" setting. Setting
18974 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18975 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
18976 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18977
18978 Example:
18979 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18980 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18981 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18982 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18983 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18984 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18985 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18986 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18987 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018988
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018989ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18990 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18991 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18992 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18993
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018994ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18995 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18996 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18997 transport layer.
18998 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18999 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19000 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19001 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19002
19003ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19004 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19005 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19006 transport layer.
19007 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19008 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19009 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19010 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19011
19012ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19013 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19014 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19015 transport layer.
19016 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19017 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19018 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19019 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19020
19021ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19022 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19023 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19024 transport layer.
19025 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19026 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19027 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19028 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19029
19030ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19031 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19032 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19033 transport layer.
19034 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19035 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19036 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19037 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019039ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019040 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19041 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019042 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19043 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19044 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19045 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019046
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019047ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19048 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19049 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19050 wait until the handshake happened.
19051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19053 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019054 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19055 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019056 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019057 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019058
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019059ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19060 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19061 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19062 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19063 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19064 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19065 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19066 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19067 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19068 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19069 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19070
19071ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19072 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19073 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19074 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19075 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19076 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19077
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019078ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019079 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019080 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19081 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019083ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019084 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019085 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19087 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19088 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19089 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19090 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19091 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019093ssl_fc_protocol : string
19094 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19095 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019096
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019097ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19098 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19099 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
19100 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater
19101 than 0.
19102
19103 Example:
19104 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19105 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19106 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19107 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19108 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19109 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19110 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19111 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19112 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19113
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019114ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019116 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19117 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019118
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019119ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19120 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19121 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19122 transport layer.
19123 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19124 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19125 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19126 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19127
19128ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19129 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19130 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19131 transport layer.
19132 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19133 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19134 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19135 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19136
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019137ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19138 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19139 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19140 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019142ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19143 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19144 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19145 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19146 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019147
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019148ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19149 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19150 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19151 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19152 BoringSSL.
19153
19154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019155ssl_fc_sni : string
19156 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19157 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019158 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19160 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19161
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019162 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019163 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019164 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019165 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019166 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019169 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19170 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19173 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19174 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019175
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019176ssl_s_der : binary
19177 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19178 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19179 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19180
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019181ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19182 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19183 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19184 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019185 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019186 does not support resumed sessions.
19187
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019188ssl_s_key_alg : string
19189 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19190 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19191 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19192
19193ssl_s_notafter : string
19194 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19195 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19196 transport layer.
19197
19198ssl_s_notbefore : string
19199 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19200 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19201 transport layer.
19202
19203ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19204 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19205 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19206 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19207 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19208 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19209 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019210 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19211 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019212 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19213 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19214 LDAP v3.
19215 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19216 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19217
19218ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19219 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19220 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19221 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19222 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19223 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19224 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019225 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19226 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019227 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19228 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19229 LDAP v3.
19230 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19231 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19232
19233ssl_s_serial : binary
19234 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19235 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19236 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19237
19238ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19239 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19240 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19241 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19242
19243ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19244 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19245 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19246 layer.
19247
19248ssl_s_version : integer
19249 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19250 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019251
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192527.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019255Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19256sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19257only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19258For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19259be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19260can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19261sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19262for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19263content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019264
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019265Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19266 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019267 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019268 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19269 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19270 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19271 sample expression). So be careful.
19272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019273payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019274 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019275 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19276 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019278payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19279 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019280 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019281 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019283req.len : integer
19284req_len : integer (deprecated)
19285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19286 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19287 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19288 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19289 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019290 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19292 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019294req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19295 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019296 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19297 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19298 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19299 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019301 ACL alternatives :
19302 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019304req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19305 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19306 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19307 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19308 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019310 ACL alternatives :
19311 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019313 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019315req.proto_http : boolean
19316req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19317 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19318 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19319 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19320 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19321 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19322 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19323 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325 Example:
19326 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19327 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19328 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019329 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019331req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19332rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19333 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19334 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19335 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19336 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19337 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19338 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19339 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19342 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19343 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19344 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19345 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19346 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348 ACL derivatives :
19349 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351 Example :
19352 listen tse-farm
19353 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19354 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19355 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19356 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19357 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19358 persist rdp-cookie
19359 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19360 # This is only useful makes sense if
19361 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19362 stick-table type string size 204800
19363 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19364 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19365 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19368 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19371rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19372 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19373 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19374 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19375 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019377 ACL derivatives :
19378 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019379
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019380req.ssl_alpn : string
19381 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19382 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19383 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19384 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19385 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19386 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019387 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019388
19389 Examples :
19390 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19391 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19392 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019393 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019394 default_backend bk_default
19395
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019396req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19397 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19398 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019399 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19400 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19401 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19402 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19403 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019405req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19406req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19407 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19408 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19409 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19410 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19411 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19412 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19413 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415req.ssl_sni : string
19416req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19417 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19418 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19419 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19420 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19421 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019422 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19423 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19424 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19425 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19426 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19427 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19428 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19429 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19430 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019432 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019433 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435 Examples :
19436 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19437 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19438 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019439 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019441
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019442req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19443 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19444 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19445 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19446 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19447 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19448 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19449 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19450 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19451 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453req.ssl_ver : integer
19454req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19455 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19456 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19457 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19458 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19459 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19460 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19461 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019462 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019465 ACL derivatives :
19466 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019467
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019468res.len : integer
19469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19470 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19471 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19472 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19473 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019474 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019475 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019476 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019478res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19479 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019480 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019481 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019482 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019483 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019485res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19486 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19487 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19488 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019489 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19490 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019493
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019494res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19495rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19496 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19497 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19498 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19499 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19500 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19501 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19502 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504wait_end : boolean
19505 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19506 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019507 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19509 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019510 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19512 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514 Examples :
19515 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19516 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19517 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019519 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19520 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19521 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19522 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19523 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19524 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19525 tcp-request content reject
19526
19527
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195287.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529--------------------------------------
19530
19531It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19532This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19533data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19534its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19535HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19536content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19537to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19538more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19539response are indexed.
19540
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019541Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19542 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19543 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19544 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19545 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19546 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19547 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549base : string
19550 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19551 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19552 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19553 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19554 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19555 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19556 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19557 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19558
19559 ACL derivatives :
19560 base : exact string match
19561 base_beg : prefix match
19562 base_dir : subdir match
19563 base_dom : domain match
19564 base_end : suffix match
19565 base_len : length match
19566 base_reg : regex match
19567 base_sub : substring match
19568
19569base32 : integer
19570 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19571 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19572 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019573 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19574 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19575 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576
19577base32+src : binary
19578 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19579 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19580 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19581 per-URL counters.
19582
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019583baseq : string
19584 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19585 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19586 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19587 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19588
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019589capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19590 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19591 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19592 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19593
19594capture.req.method : string
19595 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19596 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19597 because it's allocated.
19598
19599capture.req.uri : string
19600 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19601 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19602 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19603 allocated.
19604
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019605capture.req.ver : string
19606 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19607 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19608 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19609
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019610capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19611 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19612 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19613 The first entry is an index of 0.
19614 See also: "capture response header"
19615
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019616capture.res.ver : string
19617 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19618 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19619 persistent flag.
19620
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019621req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019622 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19623 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19624 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019625
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019626req.body_param([<name>) : string
19627 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19628 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19629 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19630 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19631 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19632 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19633 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19634 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19635 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19636 given.
19637
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019638req.body_len : integer
19639 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19640 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019641 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19642 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019643
19644req.body_size : integer
19645 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019646 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19647 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649req.cook([<name>]) : string
19650cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19651 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19652 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19653 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19654 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19655 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19656 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19657 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19658 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19659
19660 ACL derivatives :
19661 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19662 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19663 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19664 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19665 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19666 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19667 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19668 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19671cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19672 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19673 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019675req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19676cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19677 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19678 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19679 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19680 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019682cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19683 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19684 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19685 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19686 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019687 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19689 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19690 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19691 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19694 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19695 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19696 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19697 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019698 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019700req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019701 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19702 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19703 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19704 with headers such as User-Agent.
19705
19706 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19707 found.
19708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19710 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19711 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019712 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019714req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19715 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19716 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019717 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19718 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019720req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019721 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19722 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19723 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19724 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19725 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19726 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19727 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19728
19729 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19730 found.
19731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019732 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19733 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19734 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019735 with -1 being the last one.
19736
19737 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19738 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740 ACL derivatives :
19741 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19742 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19743 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19744 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19745 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19746 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19747 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19748 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19749
19750req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19751hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19752 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19753 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019754 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19755 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19756 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19757
19758 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19759 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19760 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19761
19762 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019763
19764req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19765hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19766 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19767 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19768 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019769 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19770 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19771 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19772 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19773 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019774
19775 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19776
19777 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019778
19779req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19780hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19781 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19782 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19783 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019784
19785 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19786
19787 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019788
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019789req.hdrs : string
19790 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19791 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19792 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19793 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19794
19795req.hdrs_bin : binary
19796 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19797 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19798 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19799 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19800 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19801 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19802
19803 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019804
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019805 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19806 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019808http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19809 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19810 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19811 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19812 basic auth is supported.
19813
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019814http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19815 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19816 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19817 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19818 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019819 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19820 basic auth is supported.
19821
19822 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019823 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19824 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19825 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19826 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019827
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019828http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019829 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19830 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19831 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019832
19833http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019834 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19835 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19836 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019837
19838http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019839 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19840 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19841 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019843http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019844 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19845 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019846 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19847 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019849method : integer + string
19850 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19851 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19852 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19853 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19854 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19855 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19856 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019858 ACL derivatives :
19859 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019861 Example :
19862 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19863 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19864 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866path : string
19867 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19868 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19869 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19870 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19871 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019872 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019873 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019875 ACL derivatives :
19876 path : exact string match
19877 path_beg : prefix match
19878 path_dir : subdir match
19879 path_dom : domain match
19880 path_end : suffix match
19881 path_len : length match
19882 path_reg : regex match
19883 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019884
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019885pathq : string
19886 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19887 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19888 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19889 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19890 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19891 result in both cases.
19892
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019893query : string
19894 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19895 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19896 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19897 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019898 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019899 which stops before the question mark.
19900
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019901req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19902 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19903 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19904 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19905 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019907req.ver : string
19908req_ver : string (deprecated)
19909 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19910 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19911 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019913 ACL derivatives :
19914 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019915
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019916res.body : binary
19917 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19918 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019919 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19920
19921 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019922
19923res.body_len : integer
19924 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19925 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019926 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19927
19928 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019929
19930res.body_size : integer
19931 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19932 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19933 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19934 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019935 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19936
19937 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019938
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019939res.cache_hit : boolean
19940 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19941 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19942
19943res.cache_name : string
19944 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19945 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19946 empty string.
19947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019948res.comp : boolean
19949 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19950 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19951 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019953res.comp_algo : string
19954 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19955 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19956 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019958res.cook([<name>]) : string
19959scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19960 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19961 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019962 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19963
19964 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019966 ACL derivatives :
19967 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019969res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19970scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19971 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19972 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019973 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19974
19975 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019977res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19978scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19979 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19980 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019981 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19982
19983 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019986 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19987 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19988
19989 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19990 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19991
19992 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19993
19994 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019996res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019997 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19998 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19999
20000 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20001 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20002
20003 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20006shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020007 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20008 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20009
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020010 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020011 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20012
20013 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020015 ACL derivatives :
20016 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20017 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20018 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20019 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20020 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20021 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20022 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20023 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20024
20025res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20026shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020027 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20028 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20029
20030 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020031 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020032
20033 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020035res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20036shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020037 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20038 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20039
20040 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20041
20042 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020043
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020044res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20045 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20046 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20047 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020048 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20049
20050 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020052res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20053shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020054 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20055 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20056
20057 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20058
20059 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020060
20061res.hdrs : string
20062 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20063 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20064 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020065 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20066
20067 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020068
20069res.hdrs_bin : binary
20070 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20071 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20072 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20073 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20074 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20075 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20076 (length of 0 for both).
20077
20078 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20079
20080 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20081 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020083res.ver : string
20084resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20085 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020086 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20087
20088 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020090 ACL derivatives :
20091 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020093set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20094 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20095 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020096 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020097 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020099 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20100 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020102status : integer
20103 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20104 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020105 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20106
20107 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020108
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020109unique-id : string
20110 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20111 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20112 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20113 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20114 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20115 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020117url : string
20118 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20119 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20120 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20121 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20122 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20123 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20124 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020126 ACL derivatives :
20127 url : exact string match
20128 url_beg : prefix match
20129 url_dir : subdir match
20130 url_dom : domain match
20131 url_end : suffix match
20132 url_len : length match
20133 url_reg : regex match
20134 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020136url_ip : ip
20137 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20138 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20139 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20140 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020141 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20142 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020144url_port : integer
20145 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020146 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020147
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020148urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20149url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020150 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20151 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020152 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20153 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20154 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20155 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020156 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20157 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020158 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20159 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020161 ACL derivatives :
20162 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20163 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20164 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20165 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20166 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20167 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20168 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20169 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020170
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020172 Example :
20173 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20174 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20175 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20176 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020177
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020178urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020179 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20180 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20181 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020182
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020183url32 : integer
20184 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20185 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20186 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20187 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20188 is an unsigned integer.
20189
20190url32+src : binary
20191 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20192 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20193 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20194
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020195
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200201967.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020197---------------------------------------
20198
20199This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20200used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20201purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20202There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20203or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20204any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20205for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20206
20207internal.htx.data : integer
20208 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20209 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20210
20211internal.htx.free : integer
20212 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20213 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20214
20215internal.htx.free_data : integer
20216 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20217 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20218
20219internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020220 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20221 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20222 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020223
20224internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20225 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20226 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20227
20228internal.htx.size : integer
20229 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20230 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20231
20232internal.htx.used : integer
20233 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20234 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20235 direction.
20236
20237internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20238 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20239 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20240 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20241 of the special value :
20242 * head : The oldest inserted block
20243 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020244 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020245
20246internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20247 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20248 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20249 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20250 integer or one of the special value :
20251 * head : The oldest inserted block
20252 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020253 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020254
20255internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20256 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20257 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20258 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20259 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20260
20261 * head : The oldest inserted block
20262 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020263 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020264
20265internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20266 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20267 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20268 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20269 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20270
20271 * head : The oldest inserted block
20272 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020273 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020274
20275internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20276 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20277 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20278 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20279 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20280
20281 * head : The oldest inserted block
20282 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020283 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020284
20285internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20286 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20287 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20288 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20289 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20290
20291 * head : The oldest inserted block
20292 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020293 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020294
20295internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20296 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20297 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20298 it returns false.
20299
20300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200203017.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020302---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020304Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20305every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020306order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020308ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020309---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20310FALSE always_false never match
20311HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20312HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20313HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020314HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020315HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20316HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20317HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20318HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20319LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20320METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20321METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20322METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20323METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20324METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20325METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20326METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20327METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20328RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20329REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20330TRUE always_true always match
20331WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20332---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020333
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203358. Logging
20336----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020338One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20339provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20340very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20341provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20342state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020343to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020344headers.
20345
20346In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20347about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20348send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20349
20350 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20351 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20352 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20353 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20354 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020355 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020356 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020357
20358The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20359allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20360as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20361while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20362real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20363delay.
20364
20365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203668.1. Log levels
20367---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020368
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020369TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020370source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020371HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20372in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20373track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20374syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20375about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020376
20377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203788.2. Log formats
20379----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020380
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020381HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020382and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20383slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20384options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385
20386 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20387 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20388 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20389 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20390 extents.
20391
20392 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20393 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20394 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20395 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20396 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20397
20398 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20399 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20400 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20401 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20402 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20403
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020404 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20405 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20406 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20407 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20408
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020409 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20410
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020411Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20412specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20413field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20414servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20415always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20416identifier.
20417
20418Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20419 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20420 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20421 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20422 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20423
20424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204258.2.1. Default log format
20426-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427
20428This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20429as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20430format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20431
20432 Example :
20433 listen www
20434 mode http
20435 log global
20436 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20437
20438 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20439 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20440 (www/HTTP)
20441
20442 Field Format Extract from the example above
20443 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20444 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20445 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20446 4 'to' to
20447 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20448 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20449
20450Detailed fields description :
20451 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20452 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20453 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20454 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20455 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20456 and processed the connection.
20457 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20458
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020459In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20460"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20461connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20462
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020463It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20464will eventually disappear.
20465
20466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204678.2.2. TCP log format
20468---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469
20470The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20471is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20472information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20473counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20474emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20475environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20476the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20477sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020478specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20479not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20480fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20481marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020482
20483 Example :
20484 frontend fnt
20485 mode tcp
20486 option tcplog
20487 log global
20488 default_backend bck
20489
20490 backend bck
20491 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20492
20493 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20494 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20495 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20496
20497 Field Format Extract from the example above
20498 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20499 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20500 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20501 4 frontend_name fnt
20502 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20503 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20504 7 bytes_read* 212
20505 8 termination_state --
20506 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20507 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20508
20509Detailed fields description :
20510 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020511 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020512 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20513 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020514 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020515 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020516 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020517
20518 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020519 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20520 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20521 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020522
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020523 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020524 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20525 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020526 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20527 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20528 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20529 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020530
20531 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20532 and processed the connection.
20533
20534 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20535 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20536 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20537 applications.
20538
20539 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20540 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20541 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20542 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20543 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20544
20545 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20546 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20547 See "Timers" below for more details.
20548
20549 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20550 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20551 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20552 "Timers" below for more details.
20553
20554 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020555 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020556 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20557 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20558 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20559 details.
20560
20561 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20562 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20563 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20564 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20565 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20566
20567 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20568 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20569 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20570 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20571 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20572 for more details.
20573
20574 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020575 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020576 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20577 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20578 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020579 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580
20581 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20582 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20583 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20584 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20585 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20586 caused by a denial of service attack.
20587
20588 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20589 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20590 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20591 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20592 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20593 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20594 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20595 denial of service attack.
20596
20597 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20598 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20599 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20600 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20601 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20602 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20603 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20604 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20605 be processed than on other servers.
20606
20607 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20608 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20609 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20610 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020611 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020612 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20613 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20614 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20615 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20616 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20617 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20618 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20619 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20620
20621 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20622 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20623 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20624 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20625 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20626 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020627 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020628 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20629
20630 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20631 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20632 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20633 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20634 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20635 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020636 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020637 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20638 occurs.
20639
20640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206418.2.3. HTTP log format
20642----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020643
20644The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20645is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20646the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20647are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20648emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20649generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20650"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20651which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020652frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20653is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020654
20655Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20656slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20657with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20658
20659 Example :
20660 frontend http-in
20661 mode http
20662 option httplog
20663 log global
20664 default_backend bck
20665
20666 backend static
20667 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20668
20669 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20670 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20671 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020672 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020673
20674 Field Format Extract from the example above
20675 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20676 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020677 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020678 4 frontend_name http-in
20679 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020680 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020681 7 status_code 200
20682 8 bytes_read* 2750
20683 9 captured_request_cookie -
20684 10 captured_response_cookie -
20685 11 termination_state ----
20686 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20687 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20688 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20689 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20690 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020692Detailed fields description :
20693 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020694 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020695 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20696 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020697 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020698 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020699 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020700
20701 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020702 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20703 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20704 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020705
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020706 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020707 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020708
20709 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20710 and processed the connection.
20711
20712 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20713 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20714 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20715
20716 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20717 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20718 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20719 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20720 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20721 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20722
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020723 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20724 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20725 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020726 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020727 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20728 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020729 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020730 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020731
20732 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20733 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020734 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020735
20736 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20737 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020738 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20739 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020740
20741 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20742 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20743 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20744 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20745 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020746 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20747 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020749 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020750 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20751 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20752 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20753 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20754 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20755 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020756 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020757
20758 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020759 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20760 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020761
20762 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20763 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020764 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020765 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20766 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20767 overflowing.
20768
20769 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20770 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20771 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20772 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20773 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20774 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20775 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20776 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20777
20778 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20779 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20780 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20781 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20782 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20783 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20784 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20785 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20786
20787 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20788 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20789 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20790 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20791 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20792 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20793 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20794
20795 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020796 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020797 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20798 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20799 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020800 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020801 system.
20802
20803 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20804 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20805 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20806 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20807 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20808 caused by a denial of service attack.
20809
20810 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20811 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20812 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20813 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20814 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20815 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20816 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20817 denial of service attack.
20818
20819 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20820 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20821 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20822 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20823 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20824 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20825 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20826 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20827 processed than on other servers.
20828
20829 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20830 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20831 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20832 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020833 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020834 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20835 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20836 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20837 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20838 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20839 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20840 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20841 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20842
20843 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20844 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20845 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20846 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20847 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20848 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020849 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020850 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20851
20852 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20853 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20854 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20855 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20856 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20857 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020858 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020859 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20860 occurs.
20861
20862 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20863 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20864 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20865 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20866 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20867 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20868 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20869 cookies" below for more details.
20870
20871 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20872 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20873 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20874 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20875 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20876 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20877 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20878 and cookies" below for more details.
20879
20880 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20881 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20882 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20883 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20884 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20885 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20886 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20887 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20888
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020889
208908.2.4. HTTPS log format
20891----------------------
20892
20893The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20894extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20895information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20896frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20897end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20898matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20899sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20900dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20901"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20902
20903This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20904appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20905HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020906
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020907 Example :
20908 frontend https-in
20909 mode http
20910 option httpslog
20911 log global
20912 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
20913 default_backend bck
20914
20915 backend static
20916 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
20917
20918 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20919 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
20920 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
20921 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20922
20923 Field Format Extract from the example above
20924 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20925 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
20926 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
20927 4 frontend_name https-in
20928 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
20929 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
20930 7 status_code 200
20931 8 bytes_read* 2750
20932 9 captured_request_cookie -
20933 10 captured_response_cookie -
20934 11 termination_state ----
20935 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20936 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20937 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20938 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20939 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020940 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020941 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20942
20943Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020944 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020945 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
20946 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
20947
20948 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
20949 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
20950 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
20951
20952 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
20953 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
20954 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
20955 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
20956
20957 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
20958 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
20959 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
20960 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
20961
20962 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
20963
20964 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
20965
20966
209678.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020968------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020969
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020970The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020971mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020972
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020973HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020974Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20975separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20976prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20977
20978Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20979variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020980("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020981
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020982If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020983as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020984less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20985the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20986
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020987Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20988"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20989delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20990preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020991
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020992Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20993'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20994https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20995such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20996
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020997Flags are :
20998 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020999 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021000 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21001 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021002
21003 Example:
21004
21005 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21006 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21007
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021008 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21009
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021010At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21011
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021012 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21013 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021014
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021015the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021017 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21018 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21019 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021020
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021021the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21022
21023 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21024 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21025 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21026 %sslv/%sslc"
21027
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021028and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21029
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021030 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21031 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021033Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21034
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021035 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021036 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021037 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21038 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21039 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021040 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21041 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21042 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021043 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021044 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021045 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021046 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021047 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021048 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21049 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021050 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021051 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021052 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021053 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021054 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021055 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021056 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021057 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21058 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21059 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21060 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21061 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021062 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021063 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021064 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021065 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021066 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021067 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21068 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021069 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21070 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21071 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021072 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021073 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21074 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021075 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021076 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21077 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21078 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021079 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021080 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021081 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21082 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21083 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21084 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021085 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021086 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021087 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021088 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021089 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021090 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021091 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21092 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21093 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021094 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021095 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21096 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021097 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021098 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21099 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021100 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021101 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021102 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021103 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021104
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021105 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021106
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021107
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200211088.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021109-----------------------
21110
21111When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021112protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021113By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21114"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021115will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
William Lallemand56f1f752021-08-02 10:25:30 +020021116logged if the "dontlognull" option is set. If the "log-error-via-logformat" option
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4a6328f2021-07-29 09:45:53 +020021117is set, those messages are not emitted and a line following the configured
21118log-format is emitted instead.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021119
21120The format looks like this :
21121
21122 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21123 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21124 Connection error during SSL handshake
21125
21126 Field Format Extract from the example above
21127 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21128 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21129 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21130 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21131 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21132
21133These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21134failures.
21135
21136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211378.3. Advanced logging options
21138-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021139
21140Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21141just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21142options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21143for more information about their usage.
21144
21145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211468.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21147------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148
21149It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021150HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021151commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21152monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21153ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21154
21155 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21156 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21157 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21158 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21159
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021160 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21161 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021162
21163 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21164 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21165 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21166
21167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211688.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21169----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021170
21171The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21172what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21173or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021174"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021175just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21176log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21177after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21178is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21179with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21180with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21181
21182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21184------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021185
21186Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21187for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21188"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21189retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21190raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21191a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21192file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21193you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21194"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21195
21196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21198--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021199
21200Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21201multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21202them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21203"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21204logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21205error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21206and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21207too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21208useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21209alternative.
21210
21211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212128.4. Timing events
21213------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021214
21215Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21216reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21217the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21218frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021219mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21220addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21221
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021222Timings events in HTTP mode:
21223
21224 first request 2nd request
21225 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21226 t tr t tr ...
21227 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21228 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21229 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21230 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021231 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021232 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21233
21234Timings events in TCP mode:
21235
21236 TCP session
21237 |<----------------->|
21238 t t
21239 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21240 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21241 |<------ Tt ------->|
21242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021243 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021244 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021245 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21246 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21247 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021248 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021249 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21250 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21251 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21252 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021253
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021254 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21255 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21256 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021257 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21258 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21259 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21260 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21261 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21262 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021263
21264 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21265 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21266 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21267 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21268 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21269 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21270 request typed by hand during a test.
21271
21272 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21273 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021274 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021275 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21276 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21277 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21278 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279
21280 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21281 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21282 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21283 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21284 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21285
21286 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21287 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21288 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21289 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21290 connection never established.
21291
21292 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21293 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21294 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21295 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21296 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21297 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21298 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21299 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21300 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21301 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21302 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21303
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021304 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21305 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21306 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21307 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21308 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21309 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21310
21311 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21312
21313 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21314 "Ta" can never be negative.
21315
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021316 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21317 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021318 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21319 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021320 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021321
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021322 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021323
21324 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021325 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21326 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021328 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21329 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21330 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21331 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21332 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21333 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21334 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21335 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021337These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21338protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21339that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021340due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21341"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21342that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021343
21344Most common cases :
21345
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021346 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21347 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21348 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21349 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21350 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021351 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021352 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21353 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21354 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21355 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21356 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021357 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021358
21359 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21360 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21361 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21362 of ms on remote networks.
21363
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021364 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21365 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21366 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021367
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021368 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21369 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021370 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021371 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21372 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21373 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21374 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21375 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21376 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377
21378Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21379
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021380 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021381 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021382 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021383
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021384 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021385 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21386 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21387
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021388 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021389 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21390 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21391 flags.
21392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021393 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21394 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021395 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21396 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21397 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21398 the client connection was maintained open.
21399
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021400 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021401 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021402 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021403 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21404
21405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214068.5. Session state at disconnection
21407-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021408
21409TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21410"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
214112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21412each of which has a special meaning :
21413
21414 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21415 session to terminate :
21416
21417 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21418
21419 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21420 server explicitly refused it.
21421
21422 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21423 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21424 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21425 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021426 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021427
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021428 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021429 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021430
21431 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21432 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21433 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21434 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21435 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21436
21437 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21438 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21439 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21440 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21441 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21442
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021443 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021444 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21445
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021446 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021447 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21448 backup connections when going up.
21449
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021450 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021452 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21453 send or receive data.
21454
21455 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21456 send or receive data.
21457
21458 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21459 with nothing left in the buffers.
21460
21461 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21462
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021463 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021464 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21465
21466 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21467 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21468 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21469 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21470 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21471
21472 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21473 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21474
21475 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21476 server (HTTP only).
21477
21478 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21479
21480 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21481 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21482 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21483
21484 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21485 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21486 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21487
21488 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21489
21490 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21491 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21492
21493 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21494 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21495 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21496
21497 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21498 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021499 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21500 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021501
21502 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21503 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21504 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21505 another server.
21506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021507 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021508 server.
21509
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021510 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21511 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21512 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21513 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21514
21515 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21516 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21517 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21518 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21519
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021520 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21521 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21522 "use-server" rule).
21523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021524 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21525
21526 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21527 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21528
21529 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21530
21531 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21532 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21533 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21534
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021535 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21536 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021537 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021538 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21539 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021541 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21542
21543 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21544 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21545
21546 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21547
21548 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21549
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021550The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21551was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021552helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21553starvation, attacks, etc...
21554
21555The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21556alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21557easier finding and understanding.
21558
21559 Flags Reason
21560
21561 -- Normal termination.
21562
21563 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021564 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21565 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021566 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21567
21568 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21569 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021570 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21571 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021572 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21573 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021575 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21576 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021577 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021578
21579 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21580 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21581 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21582
21583 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21584 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21585 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21586 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21587 the server takes too long to respond.
21588
21589 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21590 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21591 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21592 long a time to respond.
21593
21594 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21595 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21596 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021597 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021598 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21599 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021600
21601 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21602 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21603 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21604 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21605 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021606 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021607 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21608 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21609 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21610 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21611 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21612 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21613 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21614 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021615 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021616 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21617 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21618 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021619
21620 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21621 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021622 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21623 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21624 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21625 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021626
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021627 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021628 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21629
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021630 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021631 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21632 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021633 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021634 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21635 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21636
21637 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21638 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21639 503 or 504 here.
21640
21641 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021642 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021643 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21644 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21645 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21646
21647 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21648 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021649 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021650 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021651 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021652
21653 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21654 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21655 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21656 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21657 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21658 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021659 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021660
21661 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21662 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21663 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21664 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21665 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21666 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21667 solution is to fix the application.
21668
21669 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21670 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21671 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21672 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21673 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21674 external attacks.
21675
21676 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021677 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021678 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021679 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21680 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21681
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021682 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21683 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21684 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021685 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021686 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021688 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21689 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21690 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21691 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021692 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21693 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21694 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21695 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21696 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021697
21698 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21699 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21700 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21701 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21702
21703 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21704 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21705 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21706 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21707
21708 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21709 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21710 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21711 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021713The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021714persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021715important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21716re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21717
21718 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21719
21720 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21721 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21722 set on a GET request.
21723
21724 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21725 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021726 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021727 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21728
21729 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21730 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21731 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21732
21733 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21734 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21735 already got a cookie.
21736
21737 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21738 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21739 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21740 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21741 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21742
21743 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21744 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21745 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21746
21747 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21748 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21749 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21750
21751 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21752 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21753
21754 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21755 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21756 then advertised in the response.
21757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217598.6. Non-printable characters
21760-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021761
21762In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21763consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21764converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21765prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21766being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21767escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21768is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21769'}' when logging headers.
21770
21771Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21772issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21773containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21774
21775Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21776the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21777performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21778
21779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21781---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021782
21783Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21784achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021785section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021786cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21787the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21788the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021789locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021790not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21791user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21792a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21793wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21794
21795 Examples :
21796 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21797 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21798
21799 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21800 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21801
21802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21804---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021805
21806Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21807proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21808the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21809server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21810
21811Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21812response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021813section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021814
21815It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021816time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21817appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021818are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21819and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21820follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21821request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21822in the logs.
21823
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021824As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21825frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21826an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021828 Example :
21829 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21830 listen proxy-out
21831 mode http
21832 option httplog
21833 option logasap
21834 log global
21835 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21836
21837 # log the name of the virtual server
21838 capture request header Host len 20
21839
21840 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21841 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21842
21843 # log the beginning of the referrer
21844 capture request header Referer len 20
21845
21846 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21847 capture response header Server len 20
21848
21849 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21850 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021852 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021853 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21854
21855 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21856 capture response header Via len 20
21857
21858 # log the URL location during a redirection
21859 capture response header Location len 20
21860
21861 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21862 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21863 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21864 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21865 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21866
21867 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21868 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21869 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21870 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021871 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021872
21873 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21874 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21875 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21876 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21877 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021878 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021879
21880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218818.9. Examples of logs
21882---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021883
21884These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21885them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21886reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21887
21888 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21889 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21890 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21891
21892 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21893 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21894
21895 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21896 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21897 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21898
21899 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21900 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21901
21902 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21903 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21904 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21905
21906 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021907 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021908 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21909 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21910
21911 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21912 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21913 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21914
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021915 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21916 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21917 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21918 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021919 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021920 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021921
21922 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021923 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021924
21925 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21926 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21927 Nothing was sent to any server.
21928
21929 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21930 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21931
21932 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21933 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021934 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021935 send a 408 return code to the client.
21936
21937 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21938 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21939
21940 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21941 5 seconds ("c----").
21942
21943 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21944 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021945 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021946
21947 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021948 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021949 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21950 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21951 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21952 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21953 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021954
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021955
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200219569. Supported filters
21957--------------------
21958
21959Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21960accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21961unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21962
21963See also : "filter"
21964
219659.1. Trace
21966----------
21967
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021968filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021969
21970 Arguments:
21971 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21972 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21973
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021974 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021975
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021976 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021977 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21978 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21979 amount of the parsed data.
21980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021981 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021982
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021983This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21984callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21985information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21986filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21987
21988Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21989tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21990a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21991
21992
219939.2. HTTP compression
21994---------------------
21995
21996filter compression
21997
21998The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21999keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022000when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22001fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22002done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22003explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22004filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22005listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22006order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022007
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022008See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22009 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022010
22011
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200220129.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22013--------------------------------------------
22014
22015filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22016
22017 Arguments :
22018
22019 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22020 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22021 parsed.
22022
22023 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22024 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22025 part must be placed in its own scope.
22026
22027The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22028external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022029streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022030exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22031also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22032
22033SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22034the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22035
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022036For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022037"doc/SPOE.txt".
22038
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100220399.4. Cache
22040----------
22041
22042filter cache <name>
22043
22044 Arguments :
22045
22046 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22047
22048The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22049"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022050cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022051other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22052case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22053is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22054filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022055listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22056order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022057
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022058See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22059 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22060
22061
220629.5. Fcgi-app
22063-------------
22064
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022065filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022066
22067 Arguments :
22068
22069 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22070
22071The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22072request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22073reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22074used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22075implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22076used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22077fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22078used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22079order.
22080
22081See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22082 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22083
22084
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100220859.6. OpenTracing
22086----------------
22087
22088The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22089HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22090of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22091Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22092
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022093This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022094
22095The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22096HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22097participates in the work of HAProxy.
22098
22099filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22100
22101 Arguments :
22102
22103 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22104 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22105 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22106 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22107 OpenTracing filters.
22108
22109 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22110 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22111 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22112 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22113 filter must have its own scope defined.
22114
22115More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022116of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022117
22118
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002211910. FastCGI applications
22120-------------------------
22121
22122HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22123feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22124the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22125FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22126servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22127FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22128backend.
22129
22130HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22131application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22132connection.
22133
2213410.1. Setup
22135-----------
22136
2213710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22138--------------------------
22139
22140fcgi-app <name>
22141 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22142 document root must be defined.
22143
22144acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22145 Declare or complete an access list.
22146
22147 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22148 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22149 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22150 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22151 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22152
22153docroot <path>
22154 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22155 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22156 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22157
22158index <script-name>
22159 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22160 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22161 is an optional setting.
22162
22163 Example :
22164 index index.php
22165
22166log-stderr global
22167log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022168 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022169 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22170
22171 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22172 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22173
22174pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22175 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22176 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22177 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22178
22179 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22180 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22181 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22182 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22183
22184 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22185 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22186
22187path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022188 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022189 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22190 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22191 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22192 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22193 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22194 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22195 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022196
22197 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022198 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022199 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22200 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22201 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22202 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022203
22204 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022205 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22206 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022207
22208option get-values
22209no option get-values
22210 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22211
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022212 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022213 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22214
22215 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22216 application will accept.
22217
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022218 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22219 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022220
22221 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022222 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022223 option is disabled.
22224
22225 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22226 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22227 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22228 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22229 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22230 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22231
22232option keep-conn
22233no option keep-conn
22234 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22235 sending a response.
22236
22237 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22238 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22239
22240option max-reqs <reqs>
22241 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22242 accept.
22243
22244 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22245 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22246 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22247 to 1.
22248
22249option mpxs-conns
22250no option mpxs-conns
22251 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22252
22253 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22254 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22255
22256set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22257 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22258 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22259 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22260 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22261
22262 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22263 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22264 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22265
22266 Example :
22267 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22268 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22269
22270 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22271
22272
2227310.1.2. Proxy section
22274---------------------
22275
22276use-fcgi-app <name>
22277 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22278
22279 Arguments :
22280 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22281
22282 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22283 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22284 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22285 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22286 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22287
22288 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22289 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22290 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22291 application are evaluated.
22292
22293
2229410.1.3. Example
22295---------------
22296
22297 frontend front-http
22298 mode http
22299 bind *:80
22300 bind *:
22301
22302 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22303 default_backend back-static
22304
22305 backend back-static
22306 mode http
22307 server www A.B.C.D:80
22308
22309 backend back-dynamic
22310 mode http
22311 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22312 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22313
22314 fcgi-app php-fpm
22315 log-stderr global
22316 option keep-conn
22317
22318 docroot /var/www/my-app
22319 index index.php
22320 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22321
22322
2232310.2. Default parameters
22324------------------------
22325
22326A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22327the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022328script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022329applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22330
22331 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22332 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22333 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22334 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22335 | | |
22336 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22337 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22338 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22339 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22340 | | application. |
22341 | | |
22342 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22343 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22344 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22345 | | |
22346 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22347 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22348 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22349 | | the application's configuration. |
22350 | | |
22351 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22352 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22353 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22354 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22355 | | |
22356 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22357 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22358 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22359 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22360 | | be defined. |
22361 | | |
22362 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22363 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22364 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22365 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22366 | | is not set too. |
22367 | | |
22368 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22369 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22370 | | set. |
22371 | | |
22372 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22373 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22374 | | the request. |
22375 | | |
22376 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22377 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22378 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22379 | | |
22380 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22381 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22382 | | script to process the request. |
22383 | | |
22384 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22385 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22386 | | |
22387 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22388 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22389 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22390 | | |
22391 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22392 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22393 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22394 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22395 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22396 | | |
22397 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22398 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22399 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22400 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22401 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22402 | | side. |
22403 | | |
22404 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22405 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22406 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22407 | | connected to. |
22408 | | |
22409 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22410 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22411 | | |
22412 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022413 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22414 | | current HAProxy version. |
22415 | | |
22416 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022417 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22418 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22419 | | |
22420 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22421
22422
2242310.3. Limitations
22424------------------
22425
22426The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22427way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22428during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22429establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22430application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22431or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22432message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22433these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22434and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22435
22436Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22437request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22438requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22439
22440About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22441into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22442fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22443"http-request" ones.
22444
22445Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22446FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22447processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22448must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22449here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022450
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022451
2245211. Address formats
22453-------------------
22454
22455Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22456address.
22457
22458This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22459The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22460of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22461equivalent is '::'.
22462
22463Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22464is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22465
22466This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22467family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22468
22469Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22470configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22471use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22472'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22473
22474Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22475socket type and the transport method.
22476
22477
2247811.1 Address family prefixes
22479----------------------------
22480
22481'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22482
22483'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22484 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22485 listening.
22486
22487'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22488 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22489 on the statement using this address, a port or
22490 a port range may or must be specified.
22491
22492'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22493 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22494 using this address, a port or a port range
22495 may or must be specified.
22496
22497'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22498 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22499 using this address, a port or a port range
22500 may or must be specified.
22501
22502'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22503 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22504 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22505 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22506 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22507 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22508
22509'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22510 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22511 start by slash '/'.
22512
22513
2251411.2 Socket type prefixes
22515-------------------------
22516
22517Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22518type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22519this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22520This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22521but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22522
22523Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22524instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22525
22526If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22527they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22528report this to the maintainers.
22529
22530'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22531 to "stream"
22532
22533'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22534 to "datagram".
22535
22536
2253711.3 Protocol prefixes
22538----------------------
22539
22540'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22541 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22542 socket type and transport method is forced to
22543 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22544 this address, a port or a port range can or
22545 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22546 of 'stream+ip@'.
22547
22548'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22549 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22550 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22551 statement using this address, a port or port
22552 range can or must be specified.
22553 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22554
22555'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22556 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22557 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22558 statement using this address, a port or port
22559 range can or must be specified.
22560 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22561
22562'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22563 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22564 socket type and transport method is forced to
22565 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22566 this address, a port or a port range can or
22567 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22568 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22569
22570'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22571 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22572 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22573 the statement using this address, a port or
22574 port range can or must be specified.
22575 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22576
22577'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22578 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22579 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22580 the statement using this address, a port or
22581 port range can or must be specified.
22582 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22583
22584'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22585 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22586 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22587
22588'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22589 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22590 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22591
22592In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22593QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22594
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022595/*
22596 * Local variables:
22597 * fill-column: 79
22598 * End:
22599 */